blob: f6afbc57722995b779ad8ea6810738b2937e6446 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Christopher Faulet9f971552022-05-13 17:13:48 +02006 2022/05/13
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013111. Address formats
13211.1. Address family prefixes
13311.2. Socket type prefixes
13411.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
1361. Quick reminder about HTTP
137----------------------------
138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100139When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
141on almost anything found in the contents.
142
143However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
144formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
145correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
146
147
1481.1. The HTTP transaction model
149-------------------------------
150
151The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100152to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100153from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
154connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155will involve a new connection :
156
157 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
158
159In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
160establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
161by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
162length.
163
164Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
165to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
166however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
167response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
168header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
169
170 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
171
172Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
173power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
174but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200175a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100177Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
179second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
180page :
181
182 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
183
184This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
185latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
186correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
187the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100188server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
191time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
192are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
193parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
194carry the stream identifier.
195
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
197connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
198leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100199start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
200processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
201waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200202
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
205 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100206 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200208 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211
2121.2. HTTP request
213-----------------
214
215First, let's consider this HTTP request :
216
217 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
220 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
221 3 User-agent: my small browser
222 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
223 5 Accept: image/png
224
225
2261.2.1. The Request line
227-----------------------
228
229Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
230
231 - a METHOD : GET
232 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
234
235All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
236which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
237followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
238is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
239desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
240the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
241
242The URI itself can have several forms :
243
244 - A "relative URI" :
245
246 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
247
248 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
249 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
250
251 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
252
253 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
254
255 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
256 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
257 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
258 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
259 must accept this form too.
260
261 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
262 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
263 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200265 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
266 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
267 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
268 other protocols too.
269
270In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
271mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
272on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
273It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
274specific to the language, framework or application in use.
275
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100277assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200295as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
296normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
297representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
298HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400339over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400383 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200388 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
390 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
391 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
392
393The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3944.2).
395
396
3971.3.2. The response headers
398---------------------------
399
400Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
401the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
402details.
403
404
4052. Configuring HAProxy
406----------------------
407
4082.1. Configuration file format
409------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
411HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
412
413 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700415 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
419a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100420
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100421 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
422
423 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
424
425 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
426 tab characters
427
428 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
429 keyword sequences listed in this document
430
431 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
432 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
433 parts of the configuration, or expressions
434
435 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
436 are supported
437
438 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
439 section
440
441This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
442generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
443figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
444
445First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
446the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
447a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
448word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
449follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
450the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
451the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
452the parts that need to be addressed.
453
454A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
455requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
456extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
457the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
458section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
459section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
460not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
461
462A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
463each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
464a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
465start a new one.
466
467Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
468that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
469applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
470"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
471processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
472ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
473which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
474In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
475of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
476identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
477such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4782, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
479
480 listen foo
481 bind :80
482
483 listen bar
484 bind :81
485
486Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
487spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
488of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
489following configurations are strictly equivalent:
490
491 global#this is the global section
492 daemon#daemonize
493 frontend foo
494 mode http # or tcp
495
496and:
497
498 global
499 daemon
500
501 # this is the public web frontend
502 frontend foo
503 mode http
504
505The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
506new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
507other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
508section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
509section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
510at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
511
512Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
513are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
514editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
515support automatic indent.
516
517In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
518positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
519modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
520anymore, and is not recommended.
521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200522
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005232.2. Quoting and escaping
524-------------------------
525
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100526In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
527that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
528possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
529in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
530('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200531
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100532This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
533very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
534the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
535also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
536delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
537word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
538remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
541(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
542
543Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
544backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200545
546 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
547 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
548 \\ to use a backslash
549 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
550 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
551
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100552In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
553C-language representation:
554
555 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
556 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
557 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
558 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
559
560Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
561or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
562of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
566 # hash as a comment start
567
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100568Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
569evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
570dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
571backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
574character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
575is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
578entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
579name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
580represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
581hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200582
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100583 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
584 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
585 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
586 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
587 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
588 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
589 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
590 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
591 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
592 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
593 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594
595 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
599 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
602
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
604necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
605by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
606they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
607escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
608characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
609case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
610if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
611own quotes.
612
613The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600614quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500615not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
617
618Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
619arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
620
621 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
622 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
623
624Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
625"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
626cannot write:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629
630because we would like the string to cut like this:
631
632 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
633 |---------|----|-|
634 arg1 _/ / /
635 arg2 __________/ /
636 arg3 ______________/
637
638but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
639parenthesis then garbage:
640
641 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
642 |--------|--------|
643 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
644 trailing garbage _________/
645
646The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
647quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
648processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
649this word:
650
651 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
652 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
653 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
654
655So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
656still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
657the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
658the second level:
659
660 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
661 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
662 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
663 |---------||----|-|
664 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
665 arg2=blah ___________/ /
666 arg3=g _______________/
667
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500668Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100669double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
670
671 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
674 |---------||----|-|
675 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
676 arg2 ___________/ /
677 arg3 _______________/
678
679When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
680appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
681string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
682thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
683
684 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
685 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
686 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
687 |-------------| |-----||-|
688 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
689 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
690 arg3 ______________________/
691
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400692Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600693that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
695single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
696level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
697
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600698Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
699if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
700or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
701
702 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
705
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100706When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
707double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600708and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100709a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
710a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
711the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
712regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
713around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
714more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200715
716
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007172.3. Environment variables
718--------------------------
719
720HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
721interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
722configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
723optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
724shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200725underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
726list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
727arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
728before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200729
730 Example:
731
732 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
733
734 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
735
736 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
737
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200738Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
739file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200740
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200741* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
742 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
743
744* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
745 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
746 directory.
747
748* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
749
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500750* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200751 processes, separated by semicolons.
752
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500753* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200754 CLI, separated by semicolons.
755
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200756In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
757regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
758only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
759
760* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
761
762* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
763 starting at one.
764
765* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
766 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
767 first section.
768
769These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
770if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
771section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
772"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
773proxies.
774
775This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
776logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
777to name some config objects like servers for example.
778
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200780
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100781
7822.4. Conditional blocks
783-----------------------
784
785It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
786some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
787ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
788configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
789versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
790preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
791text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
792lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
793switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
794are defined to form conditional blocks:
795
796 - .if <condition>
797 - .elif <condition>
798 - .else
799 - .endif
800
801The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
802as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
803matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
804there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
805only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
806".elif" of a block.
807
808Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
809ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
810as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
811
812The conditions are currently limited to:
813
814 - an empty string, always returns "false"
815 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
816 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200817 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
818
819The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
820
821 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
822 exists, regardless of its contents
823
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200824 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
825 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
826 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
827
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200828 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
829 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
830
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200831 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
832 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
833 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
834 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
835
836 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200841Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200843 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
844 listen mwcli_px
845 bind :1111
846 ...
847 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100848
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200849 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
850 bind :80
851 .endif
852
853 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200854 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200855 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200856 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200857 .endif
858
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200859 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
860 profiling.memory on
861 .endif
862
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200863Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100864
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200865 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
867 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
868 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
869
870Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
871"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
872fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
873provide advice to the user.
874
875Example:
876
877 .if "${A}"
878 .if "${B}"
879 .notice "A=1, B=1"
880 .elif "${C}"
881 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
882 .elif "${D}"
883 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
884 .else
885 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
886 .endif
887 .else
888 .notice "A=0"
889 .endif
890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
892 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
893
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100894
8952.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200896----------------
897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100898Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100899values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
900otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
901numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
902for every keyword. Supported units are :
903
904 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
905 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
906 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
907 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
908 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
909 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
910
911
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009122.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200913-------------
914
915 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
916 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
917 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
918 global
919 daemon
920 maxconn 256
921
922 defaults
923 mode http
924 timeout connect 5000ms
925 timeout client 50000ms
926 timeout server 50000ms
927
928 frontend http-in
929 bind *:80
930 default_backend servers
931
932 backend servers
933 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
934
935
936 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
937 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
938 global
939 daemon
940 maxconn 256
941
942 defaults
943 mode http
944 timeout connect 5000ms
945 timeout client 50000ms
946 timeout server 50000ms
947
948 listen http-in
949 bind *:80
950 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
951
952
953Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
954
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100955 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200956
957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009583. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959--------------------
960
961Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
962are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
963of them have command-line equivalents.
964
965The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
966
967 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200968 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200970 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200971 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200973 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200974 - description
975 - deviceatlas-json-file
976 - deviceatlas-log-level
977 - deviceatlas-separator
978 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200979 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900980 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200981 - gid
982 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100983 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200984 - h1-case-adjust
985 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100986 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100987 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100988 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +0200989 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200990 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200991 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200992 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100993 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200994 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100995 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100996 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200997 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200999 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001001 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001003 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001004 - presetenv
1005 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - uid
1007 - ulimit-n
1008 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001009 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001010 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001011 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001012 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001013 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001014 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001015 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001016 - ssl-default-bind-options
1017 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001018 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - ssl-default-server-options
1020 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001021 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001022 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001023 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001024 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001025 - 51degrees-data-file
1026 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001027 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001028 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001029 - wurfl-data-file
1030 - wurfl-information-list
1031 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001032 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001033 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001036 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001037 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001039 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001040 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001041 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001042 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001043 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001044 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001045 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001046 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001047 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048 - noepoll
1049 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001050 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001052 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001053 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001054 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001055 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001056 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001057 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001058 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001059 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001060 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001061 - tune.buffers.limit
1062 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001063 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001064 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001065 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001066 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001067 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001068 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001069 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001070 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001071 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001072 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001073 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001074 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001075 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001076 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001077 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1078 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001079 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001080 - tune.maxaccept
1081 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001082 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001083 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001084 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001085 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1086 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001087 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1088 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001089 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001090 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001091 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001092 - tune.sndbuf.client
1093 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001094 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001095 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001096 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001097 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001098 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001099 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001100 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001101 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001102 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001103 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001104 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1105 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1106 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001107 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1108 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001112 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
1114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116------------------------------------
1117
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001118ca-base <dir>
1119 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001120 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1121 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1122 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001123
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124chroot <jail dir>
1125 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1126 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1127 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1128 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1129 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001130 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001131
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001132cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1133 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1134 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1135 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1136 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1137 set. These sets have the format
1138
1139 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1140
1141 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001142 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001143 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1144 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001145 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1146 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001147 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1148 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1149 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1150 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1151 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1152 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1153 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1154 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1155 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1156 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001157
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001158 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1159 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1160 on the machine's word size.
1161
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001162 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001163 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1164 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1165 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1166 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1167 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1168 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001169
1170 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001171 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1172
1173 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1174 # first 4 CPUs
1175
1176 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1177 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1178 # word size.
1179
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001180 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001181 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001182 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1183 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1184 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1185
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001186 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1187 # and so on.
1188 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1189 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1190 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001192 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001193 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1194 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1195 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1196
1197 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1198 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1199 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1200
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1202 # and a thread range.
1203 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1204 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1205 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1206
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001207crt-base <dir>
1208 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001209 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1210 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001211
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001212daemon
1213 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1214 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001215 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1216 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001217
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001218default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001219 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001220 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1221 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1222 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1223 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1224 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1225 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1226 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1227 not start with a slash ('/'):
1228 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1229 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1230
1231 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1232 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1233 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1234 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1235 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1236 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1237 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1238 each of them.
1239
1240 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1241 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1242 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1243 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1244 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1245 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1246 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1247 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1248
1249 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1250 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001251 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001252 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1253 made easily relocatable.
1254
1255 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1256 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1257 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1258 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1259 consistent across all configuration files.
1260
1261 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1262 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1263 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1264 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1265 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1266 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1267 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1268 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1269
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001270deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1271 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001272 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001273
1274deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001275 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001276 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1277
1278deviceatlas-separator <char>
1279 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1280 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1281
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001282deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001283 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1284 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1285 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001286
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001287expose-experimental-directives
1288 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1289 the config file will be rejected.
1290
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001291external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001292 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1293 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001294 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1295 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1296 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1297 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1298 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001300gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001301 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001302 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1303 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001304 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001305 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001307
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001308group <group name>
1309 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1310 See also "gid" and "user".
1311
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001312hard-stop-after <time>
1313 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1314
1315 Arguments :
1316 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1317 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1318 SIGUSR1 signal.
1319
1320 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1321 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1322 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1323
1324 Example:
1325 global
1326 hard-stop-after 30s
1327
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001328h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1329 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1330 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1331 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1332 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001333 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001334 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1335 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1336 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1337 specified in a proxy.
1338
1339 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1340 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1341 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1342 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1343 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1344 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1345 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1346
1347 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1348 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1349 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1350 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1351 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1352
1353 Example:
1354 global
1355 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1356
1357 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1358 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1359
1360h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1361 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1362 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1363 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1364 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1365 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1366 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1367 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1368 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1369
1370 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1371 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1372 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1373
1374 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1375 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1376
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001377insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001378 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001379 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1380 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1381 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1382 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1383 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1384 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1385 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001386 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001387 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1388 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1389 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1390 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1391 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1392 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1393 disable it.
1394
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001395insecure-setuid-wanted
1396 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1397 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1398 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1399 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001400 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001401 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001402 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001403 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1404 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001405 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001406 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1407 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1408 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1409 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1410
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001411issuers-chain-path <dir>
1412 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1413 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1414 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001415 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001416 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1417 "issuers-chain-path".
1418 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1419 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1420 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1421 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1422 will share the chain in memory.
1423
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001424h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1425 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1426 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1427 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1428 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1429 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1430 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1431 the keyword with "no'.
1432
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001433localpeer <name>
1434 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1435 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1436 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1437 the configuration parsing.
1438
1439 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1440 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1441
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001442log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001443 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001444 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001445 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001446 configured with "log global".
1447
1448 <address> can be one of:
1449
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001450 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001451 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1452 port).
1453
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001454 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1455 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1456 port).
1457
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001458 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001459 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1460 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001461 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001462
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001463 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1464 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1465 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1466 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1467 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1468 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1469 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1470 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1471 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1472 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001473 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001474 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1475 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1476 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001477 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1478 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001479
1480 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1481 "fd@2", see above.
1482
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001483 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1484 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1485 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1486 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1487 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1488
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001489 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1490 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001491
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001492 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1493 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1494 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1495 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1496 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1497 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1498 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1499 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1500 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1501 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001502 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1503 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001504
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001505 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1506 one of the following :
1507
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001508 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1509 field is stripped. This is the default.
1510 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1511 rfc3164.
1512
1513 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001514 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1515
1516 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1517 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1518
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001519 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1520 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1521 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1522 designed to be used with a local log server.
1523
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001524 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1525 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1526 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1527 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1528 logger consumes.
1529
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001530 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1531 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1532 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1533 used with a local log server.
1534
1535 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1536 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1537 designed to be used with a local log server.
1538
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001539 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1540 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1541 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1542 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1543
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001544 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1545 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1546 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1547 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1548 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1549
1550 <sample_size>
1551 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1552 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1553 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1554 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1555 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1556
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001557 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001558
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001559 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1560 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1561 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1562
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001563 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1564 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1565 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1566 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567
1568 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001569 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1570 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1571 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1572 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1573 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1574 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001575
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001576 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001577
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001578log-send-hostname [<string>]
1579 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1580 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1581 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1582 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1583 the logs.
1584
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001585log-tag <string>
1586 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1587 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1588 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001589 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001590
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001591lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001592 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1593 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1594 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1595 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1596 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1597 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001598 used multiple times.
1599
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001600lua-load-per-thread <file>
1601 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1602 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1603 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1604 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1605 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1606 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1607 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1608 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1609 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1610 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1611 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1612 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1613 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1614 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1615 times.
1616
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001617lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1618 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1619 variable.
1620 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1621 to "path".
1622
1623 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1624 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1625 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1626 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1627 will be checked earlier.
1628
1629 As an example by specifying the following path:
1630
1631 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1632 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1633
1634 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1635 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1636 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1637 paths if that does not exist either.
1638
1639 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1640 documentation.
1641
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001642master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001643 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1644 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1645 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001646 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001647 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1648 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001649 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1650 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1651 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1652 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1653 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001654
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001655 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001656
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001657mworker-max-reloads <number>
1658 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001659 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001660 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1661 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1662 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1663
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001664nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001665 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1666 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1667 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001668 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1669 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001670 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1671 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1672 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001673
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001674nbthread <number>
1675 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001676 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001677 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1678 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1679 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1680 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001681 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1682 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1683 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1684 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1685 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1686 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1687 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001688
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001689numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001690 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001691 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1692 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1693 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1694 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1695 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1696 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1697 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1698 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001700pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001701 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1702 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1703 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1704 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001705
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001706pp2-never-send-local
1707 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1708 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1709 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1710 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1711 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1712 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1713 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1714 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1715 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1716 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1717 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1718
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001719presetenv <name> <value>
1720 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1721 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1722 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1723 and "unsetenv".
1724
1725resetenv [<name> ...]
1726 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1727 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1728 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1729 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1730 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1731 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1732 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1733 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1734
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001735stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001736 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1737 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1738 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1739 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1740 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1741 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001742 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001743 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1744 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1745 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1746 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001747
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001748server-state-base <directory>
1749 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001750 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1751 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001752
1753server-state-file <file>
1754 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1755 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1756 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1757 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1758 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1759 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1760 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1761 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001762 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1763 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001764
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001765set-var <var-name> <expr>
1766 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1767 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1768 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1769 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1770 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1771 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1772 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1773 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1774 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1775
1776 Example:
1777 global
1778 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1779 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1780 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1781
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001782setenv <name> <value>
1783 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1784 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1785 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1786 and "unsetenv".
1787
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001788set-dumpable
1789 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001790 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1791 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1792 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1793 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1794 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1795 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1796 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1797 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1798 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1799 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1800 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1801 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1802 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1803 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1804 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001805 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001806 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001807
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001808ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1810 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001811 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001812 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001813 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1814 information and recommendations see e.g.
1815 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1816 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1817 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1818 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001819
1820ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1822 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1823 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1824 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1825 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001826 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1827 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1828 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001829 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001830
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001831ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1833 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1834 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1835 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1836 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1837
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001838ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1840 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1841 keyword to see available options.
1842
1843 Example:
1844 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001845 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001846
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001847ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1849 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001850 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001851 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001852 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1853 information and recommendations see e.g.
1854 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1855 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1856 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1857 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1858 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001859
1860ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1862 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1863 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1864 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1865 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001866 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1867 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1868 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1869 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001870
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001871ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1873 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1874 keyword to see available options.
1875
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001876ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1878 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1879 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001880 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001881 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001882 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1883 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1884 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1885 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001886 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1887 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1888 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1889
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001890ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1891 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1892 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001893 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001894 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001895 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1896
1897 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001898
1899 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1900 and won't try to remove them.
1901
1902 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1903
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001904ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001905 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001906 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1907 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1908 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001909
1910 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1911 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1912 optimize the startup time.
1913
1914 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1915 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1916 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1917
1918 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001919 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001920
1921 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001922 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1923 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001924
1925 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1926 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1927 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1928 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1929 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001930 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001931
1932 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001933 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001934 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1935 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1936 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1937 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1938 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001939 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001940
1941 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1942
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001943 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001944 a cert bundle.
1945
1946 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1947 separately in several "crt".
1948
1949 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1950 since files are loading separately.
1951
1952 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1953 required to commit them.
1954
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001955 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001956 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001957
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001958 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1959 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1960 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001961
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001962 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1963 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1964 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001965
1966 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001967 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1968 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001969
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001970 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1971 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1972
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001973 The default behavior is "all".
1974
1975 Example:
1976 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1977 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1978 ssl-load-extra-files none
1979
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001980 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1981 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001982
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001983ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1984 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1985 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1986 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1987
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001988ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001989 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001990 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1991 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1992 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1993 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1994 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1995 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001996 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001997
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001998stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1999 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2000 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2001 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002002 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002003 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002004
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002005 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2006 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2007 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002008
2009stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2010 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2011 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002012 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002013
2014stats maxconn <connections>
2015 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2016 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2017
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002018uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002019 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002020 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2021 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2022 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2023
2024ulimit-n <number>
2025 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2026 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2027 option.
2028
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002029unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2030 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2031
2032 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2033 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2034 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2035 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2036 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002037 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002038 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2039 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2040 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2041 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2042
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002043unsetenv [<name> ...]
2044 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2045 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2046 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2047 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2048 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2049 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2050 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2051
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002052user <user name>
2053 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2054 See also "uid" and "group".
2055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002056node <name>
2057 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2058
2059 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2060 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2061 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2062 traffic.
2063
2064description <text>
2065 Add a text that describes the instance.
2066
2067 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2068 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2069 "<" and ">" characters.
2070
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100207151degrees-data-file <file path>
2072 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002074
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002075 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002076 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2077
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000207851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002079 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2080 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2081 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2082
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002084 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2085
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200208651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002087 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2088 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2089
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002090 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002091 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2092
209351degrees-cache-size <number>
2094 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2095 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2096 By default, this cache is disabled.
2097
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002098 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002099 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2100
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002101wurfl-data-file <file path>
2102 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2103 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2104
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002105 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002106 with USE_WURFL=1.
2107
2108wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2109 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2110 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2111 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2112
2113 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2114
2115 Valid WURFL properties are:
2116 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2117
2118 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2119 device.
2120
2121 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2122 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2123
2124 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2125 particular web request.
2126
2127 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2128 used Libwurfl API version.
2129
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002130 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2131 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2132
2133 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2134 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2135
2136 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2137
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002138 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002139 with USE_WURFL=1.
2140
2141wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2142 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2143 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2144
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002146 with USE_WURFL=1.
2147
2148wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2149 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2150 thus before the chroot.
2151
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002152 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002153 with USE_WURFL=1.
2154
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002155wurfl-cache-size <size>
2156 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2157 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002158 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002159 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002160
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002161 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002162 with USE_WURFL=1.
2163
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002164strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002165 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002166 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2167 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002168 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002169 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021713.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002172-----------------------
2173
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002174busy-polling
2175 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2176 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2177 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2178 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2179 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2180 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2181 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2182 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2183 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2184 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2185 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2186 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2187 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2188 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2189 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2190 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2191 "poll" pollers.
2192
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002193 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2194 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2195 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2196
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002197max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002198 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002199 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2200 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2201 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2202 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2203 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2204 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2205 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2206
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002207maxconn <number>
2208 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2209 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2210 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002211 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2212 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2213 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2214 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002215 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2216 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2217 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2218 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2219 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2220 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002221
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002222maxconnrate <number>
2223 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2224 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2225 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2226 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2227 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2228 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2229 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2230 fairness.
2231
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002232maxcomprate <number>
2233 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002234 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002235 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2236 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2237 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002238 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002239 default value.
2240
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002241maxcompcpuusage <number>
2242 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2243 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2244 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002245 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. In
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002246 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2247 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2248 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2249 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2250
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002251maxpipes <number>
2252 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2253 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2254 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2255 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2256 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2257 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2258
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002259maxsessrate <number>
2260 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2261 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2262 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2263 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2264 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2265 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2266 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2267 fairness.
2268
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002269maxsslconn <number>
2270 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2271 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2272 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2273 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2274 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2275 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2276 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002277 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2278 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2279 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2280 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002281 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002282 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2283 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002284
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002285maxsslrate <number>
2286 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2287 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2288 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2289 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2290 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2291 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2292 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2293 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2294 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2295 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2296
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002297maxzlibmem <number>
2298 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2299 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2300 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002301 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2302 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2303 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2304
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002305no-memory-trimming
2306 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2307 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2308 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2309 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2310 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2311 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2312 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2313 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2314 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2315 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2316 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2317 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2318 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2319 not suffer from such a problem.
2320
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002321noepoll
2322 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2323 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002324 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002325
2326nokqueue
2327 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2328 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2329 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2330
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002331noevports
2332 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2333 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2334 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2335 also "nopoll".
2336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002337nopoll
2338 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2339 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002340 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002341 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2342 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002343
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002344nosplice
2345 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002346 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002347 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002348 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002349 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2350 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2351 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2352 "option splice-response".
2353
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002354nogetaddrinfo
2355 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2356 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2357
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002358noreuseport
2359 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2360 command line argument "-dR".
2361
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002362profiling.memory { on | off }
2363 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2364 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2365 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2366 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2367 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2368 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2369 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2370 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2371 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2372
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002373profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2374 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2375 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2376 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2377 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002378 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002379 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2380 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2381 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2382 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2383
2384 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2385 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2386 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2387 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2388 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002389 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2390 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2391 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2392 CLI.
2393
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002394spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002395 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2396 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2397 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2398 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2399 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2400 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002401
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002402ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002403 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002404 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002405 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002406 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002407 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2408 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2409 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002410 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2411 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002412 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2413 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2414 openssl configuration file uses:
2415 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2416
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002417ssl-mode-async
2418 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002419 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002420 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2421 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002422 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002423 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002424 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002425
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002426tune.buffers.limit <number>
2427 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2428 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2429 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2430 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2431 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002432 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002433 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2434 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2435 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2436 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2437 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2438 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2439 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2440 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002441 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002442
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002443tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2444 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2445 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2446 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002447 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002448
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002449tune.bufsize <number>
2450 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2451 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2452 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2453 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2454 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2455 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2456 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002457 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2458 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002459 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002460 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002461 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002462 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2463 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002464
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002465tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2466 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002467
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002468tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2469 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2470 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2471 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2472 this value. The default value is 1.
2473
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002474tune.fail-alloc
2475 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2476 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2477 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2478 gracefully.
2479
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002480tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2481 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2482 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2483 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2484 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2485 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2486
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002487tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2488 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2489 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2490 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2491 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2492 change it.
2493
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002494tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2495 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002496 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002497 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002498 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2499 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2500 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2501 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2502 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2503
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002504tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2505 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2506 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2507 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2508 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2509 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002510 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002511 recommended not to change this value.
2512
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002513tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002514 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002515 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002516 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002517 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2518 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2519 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2520 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2521
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002522tune.http.cookielen <number>
2523 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2524 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2525 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2526 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2527 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2528 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2529 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2530 to change this value.
2531
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002532tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002533 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2534 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002535 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002536 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002537 configuration directives too.
2538 The default value is 1024.
2539
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002540tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2541 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2542 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2543 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2544 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2545 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2546 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002547 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2548 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2549 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002550
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002551tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2552 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2553 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2554 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2555 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2556 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2557 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002558 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2559 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2560 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2561 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2562 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002563
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002564tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002565 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002566 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2567 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2568 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2569 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002570 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002571 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002572 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002573 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2574
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002575tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2576 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2577 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2578 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2579 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2580 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2581 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2582 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2583 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2584 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2585
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002586tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2587 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002588 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002589 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2590 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002591 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002592 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2593 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2594
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002595tune.lua.maxmem
2596 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2597 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2598 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2599 memory.
2600
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002601tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2602 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002603 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2604 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002605 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002606
2607tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2608 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2609 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2610 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2611 check servers.
2612
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002613tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2614 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2615 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2616 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002617 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002618
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002619tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002620 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2621 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002622 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2623 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2624 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2625 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2626 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2627 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2628 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2629 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2630 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002631
2632tune.maxpollevents <number>
2633 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2634 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2635 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2636 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2637 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2638
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002639tune.maxrewrite <number>
2640 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2641 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2642 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2643 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2644 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2645 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2646 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2647 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2648 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2649 bufsize.
2650
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002651tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2652 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2653 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2654 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2655 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2656 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2657 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2658 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2659 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2660 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002661 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2662 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002663 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2664 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2665 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2666 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2667 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2668 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2669 setting this parameter to 0.
2670
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002671tune.pipesize <number>
2672 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2673 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2674 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2675 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2676 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2677 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2678
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002679tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2680 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002681 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002682 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2683 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2684 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2685 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002686 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002687
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002688tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2689 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002690 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002691 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2692 default is 20.
2693
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002694tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2695tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2696 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2697 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2698 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002699 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002700 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002701 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2702 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2703
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002704tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002705 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002706 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2707 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2708 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2709 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2710
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002711tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002712 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002713 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2714 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2715 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2716 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2717 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2718 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2719 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002720
2721tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2722 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002723 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002724 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2725 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2726 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2727 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2728 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2729 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2730 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002731
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002732tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2733tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2734 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2735 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2736 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002737 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002738 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002739 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2740 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2741 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2742 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002743 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002744
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002745tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002746 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002747 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2748 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2749 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2750 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2751 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2752 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2753 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2754 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2755 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2756 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2757 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002758
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002759tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002760 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002761 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2762 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2763 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2764 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2765 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2766
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002767tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2768 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2769 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2770 performances. This is disabled by default.
2771
2772 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2773 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2774
2775 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2776
2777 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2778
2779 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2780
2781 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2782 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2783 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2784
2785 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2786 converted.
2787
2788 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2789 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2790 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2791 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2792 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2793 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2794 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002795 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2796 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002797
2798 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2799
2800 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2801 only need this line:
2802
2803 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2804
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002805tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2806 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002807 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002808 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2809 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2810 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2811 being used for too long.
2812
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002813tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2814 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2815 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2816 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2817 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2818 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2819 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2820 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2821 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2822 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2823 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002824 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002825 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002826
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002827tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2828 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2829 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2830 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2831 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002832 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002833 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2834 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002835 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2836 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002837
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002838tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2839 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2840 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2841 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2842 1000 entries.
2843
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002844tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2845 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2846 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2847 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2848
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002849tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002850tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002851tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2852tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2853tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002854 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2855 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2856 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2857 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2858 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2859 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2860 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2861 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002862
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002863 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2864 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2865 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2866 all available space is consumed.
2867 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2868 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2869 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002870
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002871tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2872 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002873 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002874 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002875 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002876 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2877
2878tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2879 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2880 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002881 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2882 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028843.3. Debugging
2885--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002886
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002887quiet
2888 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2889 line argument "-q".
2890
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002891zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002892 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002893 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2894 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2895 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2896 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2897 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2898
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029003.4. Userlists
2901--------------
2902It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2903http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2904it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2905
2906userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002907 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002908 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2909
2910group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002911 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002912 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2913 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2914
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002915user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2916 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2918 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002919 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2920 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2921 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2922 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002923
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002924 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2925 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2926 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2927 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2928 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2929 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2930 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002931 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002932 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002933
2934 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002935 userlist L1
2936 group G1 users tiger,scott
2937 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002938
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002939 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2940 user scott insecure-password elgato
2941 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002942
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002943 userlist L2
2944 group G1
2945 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002946
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002947 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2948 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2949 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002950
2951 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002952
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002953
29543.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002955----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002956It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002957several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002958instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2959values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2960automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2961In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2962using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2963tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2964reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2965Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2966that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2967each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002968
2969peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002970 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002971 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2972
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002973bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2974 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2975 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2976
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002977disabled
2978 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2979 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2980 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2981
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002982default-bind [param*]
2983 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2984
2985default-server [param*]
2986 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2987
2988 Arguments:
2989 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2990 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02002991 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
2992 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
2993 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
2994 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002995
2996 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2997
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02002998enabled
2999 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3000 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003001
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003002log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003003 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3004 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3005 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3006 more details.
3007
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003008peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003009 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3010 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003011 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003012 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003013 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3014 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3015 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003016
3017 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3018 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3019
3020 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003021 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3022 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3023 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003024
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003025 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3026 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003027
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003028 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3029 "server" keyword explanation below).
3030
3031server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003032 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003033 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3034 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3035 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3036 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003037
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003038 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3039 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3040 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3041 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3042 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003043
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003044 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003045 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003046 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003047 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3048 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3049 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003050
3051 backend mybackend
3052 mode tcp
3053 balance roundrobin
3054 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3055 stick on src
3056
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003057 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3058 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003059
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003060 Example:
3061 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003062 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3063 default-server ssl verify none
3064 server haproxy1 #local peer
3065 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3066 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003067
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003068
3069table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3070 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3071
3072 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3073 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003074 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003075 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3076 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3077 "stick-table" keyword).
3078
3079 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3080 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3081 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3082 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3083 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3084 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3085 of the stick-table name as follows:
3086
3087 peers mypeers
3088 peer A ...
3089 peer B ...
3090 table t1 ...
3091
3092 frontend fe1
3093 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3094
3095 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3096 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3097
3098 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3099 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3100 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3101 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3102 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3103 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3104 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3105
3106 peers mypeers
3107 peer A ...
3108 peer B ...
3109 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3110
3111 backend t1
3112 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3113
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003114 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003115 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3116 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3117
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031183.6. Mailers
3119------------
3120It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3121If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3122in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3123
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003124mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003125 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3126 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3127
3128mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3129 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3130
3131 Example:
3132 mailers mymailers
3133 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3134 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3135
3136 backend mybackend
3137 mode tcp
3138 balance roundrobin
3139
3140 email-alert mailers mymailers
3141 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3142 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3143
3144 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3145 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3146
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003147timeout mail <time>
3148 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3149 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3150 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3151 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3152
3153 Example:
3154 mailers mymailers
3155 timeout mail 20s
3156 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003157
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031583.7. Programs
3159-------------
3160In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3161master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3162managed the same way as the workers.
3163
3164During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3165sequence as a worker:
3166
3167 - the master is re-executed
3168 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3169 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3170 instance of the program
3171
3172During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3173
3174program <name>
3175 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3176 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3177 the management guide).
3178
3179command <command> [arguments*]
3180 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3181 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3182 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3183 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3184
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003185user <user name>
3186 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3187 See also "group".
3188
3189group <group name>
3190 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3191 See also "user".
3192
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003193option start-on-reload
3194no option start-on-reload
3195 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3196 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3197 program section.
3198
3199
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032003.8. HTTP-errors
3201----------------
3202
3203It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3204imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3205several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3206
3207http-errors <name>
3208 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3209 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3210
3211errorfile <code> <file>
3212 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3213
3214 Arguments :
3215 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003216 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003217 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003218
3219 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3220 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3221 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3222 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3223 before any chroot is performed.
3224
3225 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3226
3227 Example:
3228 http-errors website-1
3229 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3230 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3231 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3232
3233 http-errors website-2
3234 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3235 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3236 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3237
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032383.9. Rings
3239----------
3240
3241It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3242servers or traces.
3243
3244ring <ringname>
3245 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3246
3247description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003248 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003249 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3250
3251format <format>
3252 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3253
3254 Arguments:
3255 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3256 one of the following :
3257
3258 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3259 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3260 designed to be used with a local log server.
3261
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003262 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3263 field is stripped. This is the default.
3264 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3265 rfc3164.
3266
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003267 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3268 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3269 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3270 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3271 is the default.
3272
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003273 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003274 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3275
3276 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3277 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3278
3279 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3280 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3281 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3282 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3283 logger consumes.
3284
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003285 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3286 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3287 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3288 with a local log server.
3289
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003290 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3291 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3292 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3293 used with a local log server.
3294
3295maxlen <length>
3296 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3297 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3298 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3299
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003300server <name> <address> [param*]
3301 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3302 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3303 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3304 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3305 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3306 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3307 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3308 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3309 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003310 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3311 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003312
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003313size <size>
3314 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3315 set to BUFSIZE.
3316
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003317timeout connect <timeout>
3318 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3319
3320 Arguments :
3321 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3322 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3323 as explained at the top of this document.
3324
3325timeout server <timeout>
3326 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3327
3328 Arguments :
3329 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3330 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3331 as explained at the top of this document.
3332
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003333 Example:
3334 global
3335 log ring@myring local7
3336
3337 ring myring
3338 description "My local buffer"
3339 format rfc3164
3340 maxlen 1200
3341 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003342 timeout connect 5s
3343 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003344 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003345
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033463.10. Log forwarding
3347-------------------
3348
3349It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003350HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003351
3352log-forward <name>
3353 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3354
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003355backlog <conns>
3356 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3357 on connections accept.
3358
3359bind <addr> [param*]
3360 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003361 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3362 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3363 syslog protocol over TCP.
3364 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003365 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3366
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003367dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003368 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3369 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3370 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3371 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003372 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003373
3374log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003375log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003376 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3377 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3378 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003379 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003380 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3381 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3382 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003383 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003384
3385 Example:
3386 global
3387 log stderr format iso local7
3388
3389 ring myring
3390 description "My local buffer"
3391 format rfc5424
3392 maxlen 1200
3393 size 32764
3394 timeout connect 5s
3395 timeout server 10s
3396 # syslog tcp server
3397 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3398
3399 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003400 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3401 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003402 # all messages on stderr
3403 log global
3404 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3405 log ring@myring local0
3406 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3407 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3408 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3409 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3410 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003411
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003412maxconn <conns>
3413 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3414 10 is the default.
3415
3416timeout client <timeout>
3417 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034194. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003420----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003421
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003422Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003423 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3424 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3425 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3426 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003427
3428A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3429connections.
3430
3431A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3432to forward incoming connections.
3433
3434A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3435parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3436
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003437A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3438ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3439sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3440the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3441explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3442from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3443"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3444for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3445to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3446optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3447are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3448any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3449names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3450that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3451duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3452names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3453
3454Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3455settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3456of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3457profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3458timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3461'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3462case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3463
3464Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3465logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3466proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3467However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3468name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3469
3470Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3471and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003472bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003473protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3474modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3475arbitrary criteria.
3476
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003477In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3478a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003479the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003480
3481 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3482 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3483 between responses and new requests.
3484
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003485 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3486 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3487 client-facing connection remains open.
3488
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003489 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3490 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003491
3492The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3493frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3494following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003495weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003496
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003497 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003498
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003499 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3500 ----+-----+-----+----
3501 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3502 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003503 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3504 ----+-----+-----+----
3505 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003506
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003507It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003508only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3509within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003510as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003511content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003512and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3513possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003515There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003516first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003517processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003518second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003519protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3520is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3521new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003522to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003523process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3524already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3525HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3526evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3527one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3528
3529There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3530performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3531tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3532preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3533analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3534HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3535header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3536mitigate this drawback.
3537
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003538There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003539method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3540set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3541in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3542is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3543to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3544above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3545to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3546"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3547frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3548frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3549as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3550upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3551on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3552the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3553upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3554frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3555remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3558--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003560The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3561limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3562they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3563limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003564marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003565option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003566and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3567with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3568specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003570
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003571 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3572------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3573acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003574backlog X X X -
3575balance X - X X
3576bind - X X -
3577bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003578capture cookie - X X -
3579capture request header - X X -
3580capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003581clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3582clitcpka-idle X X X -
3583clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003584compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003585cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003586declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003587default-server X - X X
3588default_backend X X X -
3589description - X X X
3590disabled X X X X
3591dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003592email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003593email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003594email-alert mailers X X X X
3595email-alert myhostname X X X X
3596email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003597enabled X X X X
3598errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003599errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003600errorloc X X X X
3601errorloc302 X X X X
3602-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3603errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003604force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003605filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003606fullconn X - X X
3607grace X X X X
3608hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003609http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003610http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003611http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003612http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003613http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003614http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003615http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003616http-check set-var X - X X
3617http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003618http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003619http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003620http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003621http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003622http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003623id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003624ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003625load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003626log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003627log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003628log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003629log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003630max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631maxconn X X X -
3632mode X X X X
3633monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003634monitor-uri X X X -
3635option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3636option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3637option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3638option allbackups (*) X - X X
3639option checkcache (*) X - X X
3640option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3641option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003642option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3644option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003645-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3646option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003647option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3648option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003649option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003650option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003651option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003652option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003653option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003654option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003655option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3656option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3657option httpchk X - X X
3658option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003659option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003661option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003662option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003663option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003664option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3665option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3666option logasap (*) X X X -
3667option mysql-check X - X X
3668option nolinger (*) X X X X
3669option originalto X X X X
3670option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003671option pgsql-check X - X X
3672option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003673option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003674option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003675option smtpchk X - X X
3676option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3677option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3678option splice-request (*) X X X X
3679option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003680option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003681option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3682option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3683-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003684option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003685option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3686option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3687option tcpka X X X X
3688option tcplog X X X X
3689option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003690option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003691external-check command X - X X
3692external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003693persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3694rate-limit sessions X X X -
3695redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003697retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003698retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003699server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003700server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003701server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003702source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003703srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3704srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3705srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003706stats admin - X X X
3707stats auth X X X X
3708stats enable X X X X
3709stats hide-version X X X X
3710stats http-request - X X X
3711stats realm X X X X
3712stats refresh X X X X
3713stats scope X X X X
3714stats show-desc X X X X
3715stats show-legends X X X X
3716stats show-node X X X X
3717stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003718-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3719stick match - - X X
3720stick on - - X X
3721stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003722stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003723stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003724tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003725tcp-check connect X - X X
3726tcp-check expect X - X X
3727tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003728tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003729tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003730tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003731tcp-check set-var X - X X
3732tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003733tcp-request connection - X X -
3734tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003735tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003736tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003737tcp-response content - - X X
3738tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003739timeout check X - X X
3740timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003741timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003742timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003743timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3744timeout http-request X X X X
3745timeout queue X - X X
3746timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003747timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003748timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003749timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003750transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003751unique-id-format X X X -
3752unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003753use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003754use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003755use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003756------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3757 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003758
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3761---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003762
3763This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3764
3765
3766acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3767 Declare or complete an access list.
3768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3769 no | yes | yes | yes
3770 Example:
3771 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3772 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3773 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003775 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003776
3777
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003778backlog <conns>
3779 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3781 yes | yes | yes | no
3782 Arguments :
3783 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3784 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003785 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003786
3787 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3788 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3789 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3790 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3791 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3792 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3793 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3794 backlog parameter.
3795
3796 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3797 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3798 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3799
3800 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3801
3802
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003803balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003804balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003805 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3807 yes | no | yes | yes
3808 Arguments :
3809 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3810 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3811 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3812 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3813
3814 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3815 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3816 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3817 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003818 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003819 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003820 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3821 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3822 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3823 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3824 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3825 it, so that you don't worry.
3826
3827 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3828 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3829 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3830 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3831 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3832 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3833 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3834 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003835
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003836 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3837 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3838 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3839 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3840 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3841 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3842 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003843 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3844 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3845 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003846
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003847 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003848 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003849 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3850 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003851 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003852 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3853 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3854 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3855 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3856 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003857 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3858 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3859 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3860 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3861 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3862 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003864 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3865 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3866 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3867 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3868 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3869 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3870 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3871 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003872 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003873 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003874 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3875 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3876 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003877
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003878 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3879 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3880 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3881 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3882 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3883 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3884 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3885 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3886 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3887 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3888 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3889 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003890
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003891 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003892 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3893 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3894 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3895 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3896 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3897 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3898 URIs start with a leading "/".
3899
3900 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3901 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3902 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3903 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3904
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003905 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3906 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3907 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3908 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3909
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003910 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003911 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3912
3913 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003914 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3915 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003916 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3917 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3918 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3919 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003920 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003921 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3922 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003923
3924 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3925 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3926 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3927 server will receive the request.
3928
3929 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3930 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3931 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3932 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3933 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003934 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3935 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3936 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003937
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003938 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3939 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3940 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3941 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3942 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003944 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003945 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3946 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3947 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3948
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003949 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3950 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3951 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3952
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003953 random
3954 random(<draws>)
3955 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003956 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3957 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3958 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3959 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003960 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3961 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3962 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3963 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3964 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3965 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3966 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3967 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3968 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3969 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3970 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3971 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3972 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3973 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3974 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3975 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3976 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3977 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3978 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3979 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003980
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003981 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003982 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003983 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3984 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003985 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003986 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3987 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3988 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003989 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003990 used instead.
3991
3992 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3993 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3994 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003995 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003996
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003997 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3998 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3999 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4000
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004001 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004002 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4003 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004004
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004005 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4006 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4007 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004008
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004009 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004010 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004011 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4012 NTLM relies on.
4013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004014 Examples :
4015 balance roundrobin
4016 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004017 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004018 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4019 balance hdr(host)
4020 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004021
4022 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4023 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004025 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004026 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4027 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4028 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004029 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004030
4031 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4032 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4033 defaults to 16 kB.
4034
4035 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4036 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4037
4038 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4039 Round Robin.
4040
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004041 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004042 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4043 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4044 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4045
4046 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4047
4048 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004049 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004050 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4051 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4052 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004053
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004054 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004055
4056
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004057bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4058bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004059 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4061 no | yes | yes | no
4062 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004063 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4064 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4065 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4066 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004067 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004068 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4069 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4070 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4071 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4072 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4073 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004074 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004075 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4076 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004077 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004078 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4079 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004080 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004081 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4082 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004083 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004084 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4085 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4086 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4087 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4088 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4089 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4090 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004091 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4092 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4093 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004094 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4095 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4096 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4097 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004098 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4099 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4100 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004101
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004102 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4103 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004104 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4105 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4106 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004107 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4108 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4109 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4110 the range.
4111
4112 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4113 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4114 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4115 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4116 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4117 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4118 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004119 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004120 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004122 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004123 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004124 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4125 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4126 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4127 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4128 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4129 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4130
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004131 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4132 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4133 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4134 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004135
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004136 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4137 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4138 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4139 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4140 in a frontend.
4141
4142 Example :
4143 listen http_proxy
4144 bind :80,:443
4145 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004146 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004148 listen http_https_proxy
4149 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004150 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004151
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004152 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4153 bind ipv6@:80
4154 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4155 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4156
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004157 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004158 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004159
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004160 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4161 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4162 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4163 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4164 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4165
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004166 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004167 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168
4169
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004170bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004171 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4173 yes | yes | yes | yes
4174 Arguments :
4175 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4176 may be used to override a default value.
4177
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004178 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004179 option may be combined with other numbers.
4180
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004181 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004182 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4183 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4184 missing from all processes.
4185
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004186 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004187 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004188 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4189 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4190 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4191 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4192 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004193 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004194
4195 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4196 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4197 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4198 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4199 and 'even' instances.
4200
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004201 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4202 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4203 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4204 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004205
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004206 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4207 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4208
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004209 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4210 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4211 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4212
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004213 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4214 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4215
4216 Example :
4217 listen app_ip1
4218 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004219 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004220
4221 listen app_ip2
4222 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004223 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004224
4225 listen management
4226 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004227 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004228
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004229 listen management
4230 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4231 bind-process 1-4
4232
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004233 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004234
4235
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004236capture cookie <name> len <length>
4237 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4239 no | yes | yes | no
4240 Arguments :
4241 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4242 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4243 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4244 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004245 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004246
4247 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4248 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4249 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4250 right if it exceeds <length>.
4251
4252 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4253 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4254 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4255 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4256
4257 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4258 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4259 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4260
4261 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4262 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4263 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004264 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4265 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4266 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004267
4268 Example:
4269 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4270
4271 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004272 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004273
4274
4275capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004276 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4278 no | yes | yes | no
4279 Arguments :
4280 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004281 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004282 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4283 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4284 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4285
4286 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4287 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4288 it exceeds <length>.
4289
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004290 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004291 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4292 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004293 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4294 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4295 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4296 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004297 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004298 environments to find where the request came from.
4299
4300 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4301 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4302 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4303 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004304
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004305 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4306 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4307 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4308 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4309 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004310
4311 Example:
4312 capture request header Host len 15
4313 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004314 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004316 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004317 about logging.
4318
4319
4320capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004321 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4323 no | yes | yes | no
4324 Arguments :
4325 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004326 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004327 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4328 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4329 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4330
4331 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4332 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4333 it exceeds <length>.
4334
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004335 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004336 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4337 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4338 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004339 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4340 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4341 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4342 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004343
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004344 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4345 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4346 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4347 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4348 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349
4350 Example:
4351 capture response header Content-length len 9
4352 capture response header Location len 15
4353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004354 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004355 about logging.
4356
4357
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004358clitcpka-cnt <count>
4359 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4360 the connection on the client side.
4361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4362 yes | yes | yes | no
4363 Arguments :
4364 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4365
4366 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4367 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004368 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4369 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004370
4371 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4372
4373
4374clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4375 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4376 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4377 client side.
4378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 yes | yes | yes | no
4380 Arguments :
4381 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4382 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4383 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4384 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4385
4386 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4387 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004388 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4389 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004390
4391 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4392
4393
4394clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4395 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4397 yes | yes | yes | no
4398 Arguments :
4399 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4400 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4401 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4402 document.
4403
4404 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4405 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004406 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4407 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004408
4409 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4410
4411
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004412compression algo <algorithm> ...
4413compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004414compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004415 Enable HTTP compression.
4416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4417 yes | yes | yes | yes
4418 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004419 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4420 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004421 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004422
4423 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004424 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4425 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4426 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004427
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004428 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004429 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004430
4431 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4432 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4433 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4434 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4435 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004436 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004437
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004438 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4439 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4440 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4441 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4442 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4443 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4444 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004445 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004446
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004447 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004448 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004449 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004450 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004451 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004452 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004453 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004454
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004455 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004456 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4457 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004458 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4459 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004460 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004461 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004462 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4463 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004464 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004465 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4466 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004467
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004468 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004469 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4470 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004471 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004472 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004473 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4474 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4475 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4476 "multipart"
4477 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4478 header
4479 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4480 and later
4481 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4482 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004483 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004484
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004485 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004486
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004487 Examples :
4488 compression algo gzip
4489 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004491
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004492cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004493 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4494 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004495 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004496 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4498 yes | no | yes | yes
4499 Arguments :
4500 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4501 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4502 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4503 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4504 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4505 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004506 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004507 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4508 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4509
4510 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004511 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4513 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4514 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4515 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004516 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4517 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004518 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004519 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4520 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004521
4522 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004523 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004524
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004525 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004526 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004527 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004528 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004529 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4530 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4531 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4532 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4533 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4534 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4535 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004536
4537 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4538 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4539 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4540 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4541 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4542 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4543 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4544 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4545 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004546 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004547 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4548 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4549 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004550
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004551 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4552 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4553 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004554 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4555 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4556 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4557 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004558 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4559 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4560 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004561
4562 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4563 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4564 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4565 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4566 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4567 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4568 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4569 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4570 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4571
4572 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4573 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4574 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4575 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4576 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4577 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4578 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4579 persistence cookie in the cache.
4580 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4581
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004582 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4583 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004584 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004585 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4586 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004587 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004588 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4589 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4590 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4591 they logout.
4592
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004593 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004594 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4595 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4596 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004598 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004599 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4600 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4601 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4602 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4603 this attribute.
4604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004605 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004606 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004607 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4608 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4609 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4610 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4611 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4612 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004613
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004614 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4615 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4616 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4617 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4618 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4619 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4620 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4621 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004622 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004623 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4624 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4625 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4626 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4627 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4628 the site.
4629
4630 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4631 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4632 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4633 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4634 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4635 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4636 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4637 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4638 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4639 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4640 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4641 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4642 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004643 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004644 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4645 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4646
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004647 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4648 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4649 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4650 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4651 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4652 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4653
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004654 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004655 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4656 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4657 repeated.
4658
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004659 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4660 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4661 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4662 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004663
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004664 Examples :
4665 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4666 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4667 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004668 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004669
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004670 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004671
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004672
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004673declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4674 Declares a capture slot.
4675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4676 no | yes | yes | no
4677 Arguments:
4678 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4679
4680 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4681 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4682 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4683 for use in the response.
4684
4685 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004686 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004687 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4688
4689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004690default-server [param*]
4691 Change default options for a server in a backend
4692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4693 yes | no | yes | yes
4694 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004695 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4696 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4697 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4698 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004699
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004700 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004701 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4702
4703 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004704
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004705
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004706default_backend <backend>
4707 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 yes | yes | yes | no
4710 Arguments :
4711 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4712
4713 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4714 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4715 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4716 will catch all undetermined requests.
4717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004718 Example :
4719
4720 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4721 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4722 default_backend dynamic
4723
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004724 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004725
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004726
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004727description <string>
4728 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4730 no | yes | yes | yes
4731 Arguments : string
4732
4733 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4734 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4735 it describes.
4736 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4737
4738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004739disabled
4740 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4742 yes | yes | yes | yes
4743 Arguments : none
4744
4745 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4746 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4747 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4748 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4749 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4750 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4751 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4752
4753 See also : "enabled"
4754
4755
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004756dispatch <address>:<port>
4757 Set a default server address
4758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4759 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004760 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004761
4762 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4763 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4764 during start-up.
4765
4766 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4767 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4768 possible with normal servers.
4769
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004770 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004771 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4772 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4773 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4774 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4775
4776 See also : "server"
4777
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004778
4779dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4780 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4782 yes | no | yes | yes
4783 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4784
4785 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004786 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004787 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4788 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004789 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004790 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004791
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004792enabled
4793 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4795 yes | yes | yes | yes
4796 Arguments : none
4797
4798 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4799 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4800
4801 See also : "disabled"
4802
4803
4804errorfile <code> <file>
4805 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 yes | yes | yes | yes
4808 Arguments :
4809 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004810 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004811 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004812
4813 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004814 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004815 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004816 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4817 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004818
4819 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4820 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4821 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4822
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004823 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4824
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004825 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4826 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4827 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4828 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4829 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4830 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4831 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4832 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4833 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004834
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004835 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4836 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4837 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004838 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004839 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4840
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004841 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004842
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004843 Example :
4844 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004845 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004846 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4847 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004849
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004850errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4851 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4852 section.
4853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4854 yes | yes | yes | yes
4855 Arguments :
4856 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4857
4858 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004859 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004860 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4861 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004862
4863 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4864 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4865 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4866 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4867 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004868 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004869 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4870
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004871 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4872 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004873
4874 Example :
4875 errorfiles generic
4876 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4877
4878
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004879errorloc <code> <url>
4880errorloc302 <code> <url>
4881 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4883 yes | yes | yes | yes
4884 Arguments :
4885 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004886 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004887 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004888
4889 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4890 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4891 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4892 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004893 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004894
4895 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4896 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4897 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4898
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004899 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4900
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004901 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4902 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4903 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4904 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004905 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004906 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4907 request.
4908
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004909 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004910
4911
4912errorloc303 <code> <url>
4913 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4915 yes | yes | yes | yes
4916 Arguments :
4917 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004918 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004919 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004920
4921 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4922 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4923 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4924 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004925 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926
4927 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4928 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4929 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4930
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004931 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4932
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004933 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4934 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4935 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4936 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004937 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004938
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004939 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004940
4941
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004942email-alert from <emailaddr>
4943 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004944 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4946 yes | yes | yes | yes
4947
4948 Arguments :
4949
4950 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4951
4952 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4953 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4954
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004955 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004956 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4957 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004958
4959
4960email-alert level <level>
4961 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4962 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4964 yes | yes | yes | yes
4965
4966 Arguments :
4967
4968 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4969 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4970 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4971
4972 By default level is alert
4973
4974 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4975 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4976 for the proxy.
4977
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004978 Alerts are sent when :
4979
4980 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4981 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4982 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4983 is notice or lower
4984 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4985 and a health check status update occurs
4986
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004987 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4988 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004989 section 3.6 about mailers.
4990
4991
4992email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4993 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4995 yes | yes | yes | yes
4996
4997 Arguments :
4998
4999 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5000
5001 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5002 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5003
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005004 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5005 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005006
5007
5008email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5009 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5010 mailers.
5011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5012 yes | yes | yes | yes
5013
5014 Arguments :
5015
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005016 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005017
5018 By default the systems hostname is used.
5019
5020 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5021 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5022 for the proxy.
5023
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005024 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5025 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005026
5027
5028email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005029 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005030 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5031 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5032 yes | yes | yes | yes
5033
5034 Arguments :
5035
5036 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5037
5038 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5039 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5040
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005041 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005042 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5043
5044
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005045force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5046 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5047 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005048 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005049
5050 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5051 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5052 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5053 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5054 marked down for maintenance operations.
5055
5056 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5057 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5058 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5059 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5060 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5061 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5062 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5063 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5064 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5065
5066 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5067 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5068 is used.
5069
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005070 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005071 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005072
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005073
5074filter <name> [param*]
5075 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5077 no | yes | yes | yes
5078 Arguments :
5079 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5080 referenced in section 9.
5081
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005082 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005083 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005084 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5085 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005086
5087 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5088 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5089
5090 Example:
5091 listen
5092 bind *:80
5093
5094 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5095 filter compression
5096 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5097
5098 compression algo gzip
5099 compression offload
5100
5101 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5102
5103 See also : section 9.
5104
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005105
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005106fullconn <conns>
5107 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5109 yes | no | yes | yes
5110 Arguments :
5111 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5112 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5113
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005114 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005115 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005116 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005117 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5118 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5119 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5120 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5121 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005122 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005123
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005124 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005125 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005126 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5127 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5128 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005129
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005130 Example :
5131 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5132 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5133 # connections.
5134 backend dynamic
5135 fullconn 10000
5136 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5137 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5138
5139 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5140
5141
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005142grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005143 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005145 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005146 Arguments :
5147 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5148 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5149 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5150
5151 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5152 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005153 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005154 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5155
5156 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5157 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5158 simplify it.
5159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005160
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005161hash-balance-factor <factor>
5162 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | no | no | yes
5165 Arguments :
5166 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5167 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005168 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005169
5170 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5171 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5172 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5173 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5174 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5175 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5176 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5177
5178 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5179 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5180 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5181 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5182 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5183
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005184 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5185 consistent hashing mechanism.
5186
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005187 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5188
5189
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005190hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005191 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5193 yes | no | yes | yes
5194 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005195 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5196 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005197
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005198 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5199 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5200 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5201 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5202 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5203 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5204 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5205 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5206 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5207 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005208
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005209 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5210 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5211 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5212 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5213 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5214 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5215 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5216 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5217 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5218 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5219 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5220 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5221 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005222 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5223 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005224
5225 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5226
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005227 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005228 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5229 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5230 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005231 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5232 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5233 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005234
5235 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5236 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005237 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5238 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5239 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5240 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5241
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005242 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005243 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5244 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5245 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5246 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5247 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5248 parameter.
5249
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005250 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5251 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5252 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5253 used on strings.
5254
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005255 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5256
5257 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5258 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5259 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5260 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5261 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5262 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5263 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5264 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5265 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5266 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5267 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5268 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005269
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005270 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5271 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5272 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005273
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005274 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005275
5276
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005277http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5278 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5279 ones).
5280
5281 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5282 no | yes | yes | yes
5283
5284 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5285 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5286 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5287 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5288 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5289 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5290
5291 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5292 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5293 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5294
5295 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5296 below.
5297
5298 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5299 instance.
5300
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005301 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5302 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5303 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5304
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005305 Example:
5306 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5307 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5308 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5309
5310http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5311
5312 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5313 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5314 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5315 example, or to pass some internal information.
5316 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5317 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5318 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5319
5320http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5321
5322 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5323 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5324
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005325http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005326
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005327 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5328 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5329 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5330 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5331 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005332
5333http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5334 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5335
5336 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5337
5338 Example:
5339 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5340
5341 # applied to:
5342 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5343
5344 # outputs:
5345 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5346
5347 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5348
5349http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5350 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5351
5352 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5353
5354 Example:
5355 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5356
5357 # applied to:
5358 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5359
5360 # outputs:
5361 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5362
5363http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5364
5365 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5366 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5367 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5368
5369http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5370 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5371
5372 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5373 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5374 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5375 fallback.
5376
5377 Example:
5378 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5379 http-response set-status 431
5380 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5381 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5382
5383http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5384
5385 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5386 inline.
5387
5388 Arguments:
5389 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5390 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5391 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5392 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5393 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5394 (request and response)
5395 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5396 processing
5397 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5398 processing
5399 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5400 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5401 and '_'.
5402
5403 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5404 followed by some converters.
5405
5406 Example:
5407 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5408
5409http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5410
5411 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5412 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5413 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5414 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5415 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005416 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005417 processing.
5418
5419 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5420 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005421 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005422 rules evaluation.
5423
5424http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5425
5426 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5427 details about <var-name>.
5428
5429 Example:
5430 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5431
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005432
5433http-check comment <string>
5434 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5435 it fails.
5436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 yes | no | yes | yes
5438
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005439 Arguments :
5440 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5441 rule fails.
5442
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005443 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5444 user-friendly error reporting.
5445
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005446 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005447 "http-check expect".
5448
5449
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005450http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5451 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005452 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005453 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 yes | no | yes | yes
5456
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005457 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005458 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5459
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005460 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005461 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005462
5463 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5464 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5465 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5466 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5467
5468 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5469
5470 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5471
5472 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5473
5474 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5475
5476 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5477
5478 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5479 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5480 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5481 is used.
5482
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005483 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5484 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5485 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5486 haproxy -vv.
5487
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005488 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5489
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005490 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5491 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5492 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5493 different ports or with different servers.
5494
5495 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5496 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5497 the port with a "http-check connect".
5498
5499 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5500 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5501 do.
5502
5503 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5504 unset-var or comment rules.
5505
5506 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005507 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5508 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5509 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5510 option httpchk
5511
5512 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005513 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005514 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005515 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005516 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005517 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005518
5519 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5520
5521 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005522
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005524http-check disable-on-404
5525 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005527 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005528 Arguments : none
5529
5530 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5531 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5532 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5533 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5534 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5535 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5536 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5537 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005538 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5539 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005540 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5541 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5542 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005543
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005544 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005545
5546
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005547http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005548 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5549 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5550 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005551 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005553 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005554
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005555 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005556 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5557
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005558 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5559 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5560 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5561 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5562 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5563 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5564 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5565 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5566 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5567 result is always conclusive.
5568
5569 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5570 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5571 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005572 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5573 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005574 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5575 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005576 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5577 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5578 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005579
5580 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5581 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005582 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5583 supported :
5584 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5585 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005586 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5587 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5588 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5589 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5590 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005591
5592 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5593 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005594 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5595 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5596 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5597 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005598 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5599
5600 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5601 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5602 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5603 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5604
5605 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5606 informational message reported in logs if an error
5607 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5608 log-format string.
5609
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005610 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005611 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5612 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005613 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5614 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5615 details on the supported keywords.
5616
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005617 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5618 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5619 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5620 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005621
5622 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5623 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5624 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5625 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5626 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5627
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005628 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5629 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5630 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5631 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5632 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5633 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5634 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005635
5636 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005637 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005638 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5639 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5640 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5641 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5642
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005643 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5644 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005645 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5646 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5647 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5648 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5649 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5650 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5651 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5652 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005653 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5654 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5655 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5656 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5657 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5658 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5659 insensitive on the header names.
5660
5661 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5662 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5663 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5664 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5665 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5666 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005667
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005668 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005669 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005670 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5671 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5672 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5673 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5674 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005675 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005676 trace).
5677
5678 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005679 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005680 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5681 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5682 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5683 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5684 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005685 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005686
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005687 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5688 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5689 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5690 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5691 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5692 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5693
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005694 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005695 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005696 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5697 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5698 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5699 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5700 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5701 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5702
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005703 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5704 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5705 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5706 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5707 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005708
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005709 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5710 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5711
5712 Examples :
5713 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005714 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005715
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005716 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5717 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5718
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005719 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005720 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005721
5722 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005723 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005724
5725 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005726 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005727
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005728 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005729 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005730
5731
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005732http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005733 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5734 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005735 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5736 health checks.
5737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5738 yes | no | yes | yes
5739 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005740 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5741
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005742 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5743 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5744 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5745 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5746 to invent non-standard ones.
5747
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005748 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5749 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5750 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5751 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5752
5753 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5754 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5755 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5756 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005757
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005758 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005759 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005760 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005761 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5762 to add it.
5763
5764 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5765 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5766 to the log-format rules.
5767
5768 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5769 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5770 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005771
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005772 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5773 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5774 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5775 request.
5776
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005777 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5778 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5779 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005780 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5781 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5782 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5783 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005784 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005785
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005786 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005787 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5788 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005789
5790 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5791 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5792 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5793 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5794 configured request authority.
5795
5796 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5797 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005798
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005799 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005800
5801
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005802http-check send-state
5803 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5805 yes | no | yes | yes
5806 Arguments : none
5807
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005808 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005809 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005810 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5811 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5812 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005813
5814 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5815 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5816 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5817 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5818 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005819 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5820 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5821 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5822
5823 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5824 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5825 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5826
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005827 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5828 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5829 checked in multiple backends.
5830
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005831 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005832 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5833
5834 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5835 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5836 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5837 one fails.
5838
5839 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5840 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5841 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5842
5843 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5844 server's queue.
5845
5846 Example of a header received by the application server :
5847 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5848 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5849
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005850 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5851 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005852
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005853
5854http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005855 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005856 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 yes | no | yes | yes
5858
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005859 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005860 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5861 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5862 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5863 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5864 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5865 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5866 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5867 and '-'.
5868
5869 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5870
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005871 Examples :
5872 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005873
5874
5875http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005876 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005877 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5878 yes | no | yes | yes
5879
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005880 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005881 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5882 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5883 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5884 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5885 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5886 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5887 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5888 and '-'.
5889
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005890 Examples :
5891 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005893
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005894http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5895 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5896 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5897 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5898 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5900 yes | yes | yes | yes
5901 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005902 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005903 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005904 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005905 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005906
5907 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5908 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5909 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5910 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5911
5912 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5913 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5914 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5915 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5916
5917 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5918 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5919 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5920 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5921 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5922 chroot is performed.
5923
5924 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5925 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5926 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5927 considered.
5928
5929 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5930 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5931 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5932 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5933 considered as a raw string.
5934
5935 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5936 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5937 "content-type".
5938
5939 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5940 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5941 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5942 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5943 evaluated as a log-format string.
5944
5945 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5946 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5947 argument to "content-type".
5948
5949 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5950 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5951 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5952 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5953
5954 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5955 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5956 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5957 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5958 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5959 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5960 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5961 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5962
5963 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5964 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5965 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5966
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005967 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5968 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5969 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5970 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5971 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5972
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005973 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5974 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5975
5976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005977http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005978 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5979
5980 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5981 no | yes | yes | yes
5982
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005983 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5984 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5985 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5986 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5987 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005989 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5990 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005991
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005992 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005994 Example:
5995 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5996 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5997 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999 http-request allow if nagios
6000 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6001 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6002 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004 Example:
6005 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6006 acl add path /addacl
6007 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006011 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6012 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014 Example:
6015 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6016 acl setmap path /setmap
6017 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6022 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6025 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006027http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006029 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6030 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6031 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6032 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6033 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6034 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6035 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6036 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006037
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006038http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006040 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6041 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6042 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6043 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6044 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6045 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6046 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6047 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006049http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6052 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006053
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006057 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6058 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6059 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6060 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6061 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006062
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006063 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6064 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6065 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6066 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6067 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6068 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6069 instead.
6070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006071 Example:
6072 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6073 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006074
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006075http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006076
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006077 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006079http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6080 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006082 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6083 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6084 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6085 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6086 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6087 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6088 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6089 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6090 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006092 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6093 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6094 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006095 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6096
6097 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6098 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6099 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6100 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006102http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006104 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6105 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6106 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6107 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6108 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6109 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006110
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006111http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006112
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006113 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6114 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6115 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6116 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6117 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006119http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006121 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6122 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6123 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6124 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6125 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6126 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006127
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006128http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6129http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6130 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6131 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6132 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6133 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006134
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006135 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6136 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6137 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006138 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006139 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6140 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6141 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006142 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006143 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006144
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006145http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6146 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6147 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6148 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6149
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006150http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6151
6152 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6153 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6154 pointed by <resolvers>.
6155 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6156 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6157 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6158 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6159 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6160 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6161 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6162 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6163 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6164 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6165 to 0.0.0.0.
6166
6167 Example:
6168 resolvers mydns
6169 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6170 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6171 timeout retry 1s
6172 hold valid 10s
6173 hold nx 3s
6174 hold other 3s
6175 hold obsolete 0s
6176 accepted_payload_size 8192
6177
6178 frontend fe
6179 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6180 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6181 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6182
6183 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6184 # which mean DNS resolution error
6185 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6186
6187 default_backend be
6188
6189 backend b_503
6190 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6191 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6192 # 503 error page to end users
6193
6194 backend be
6195 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6196 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6197 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6198 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6199 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6200
6201 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6202 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6203
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006204http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6205
6206 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6207 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6208 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6209 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006210 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6211 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006212
6213 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6214
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006215http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006216http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006217http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006218http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006219http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006220http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006221http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006222http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6223http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006224
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006225 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6226
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006227 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006228 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6229 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6230 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6231 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006232
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006233 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6234 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6235 the supported backend.
6236
6237 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6238 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6239 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6240 number of segments in the path.
6241
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006242 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6243 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6244 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6245 when improperly combined.
6246
6247 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6248 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6249 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6250 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6251 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6252
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006253 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006254
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006255 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6256
6257 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6258 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6259
6260 Example:
6261 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6262
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006263 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6264
6265 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6266 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6267
6268 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6269 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6270
6271 Example:
6272 - /#foo -> /
6273
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006274 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6275 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006276
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006277 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6278 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6279
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006280 Example:
6281 - /. -> /
6282 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6283 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6284 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006285
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006286 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6287 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6288
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006289 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006290 their preceding segment.
6291
6292 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6293 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6294
6295 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6296 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006297
6298 Example:
6299 - /foo/../ -> /
6300 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6301 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6302 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006303 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006304 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006305 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006306
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006307 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6308 removed as well:
6309
6310 Example:
6311 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6312 - /bar/../../ -> /
6313
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006314 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6315 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006316
6317 Example:
6318 - // -> /
6319 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6320
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006321 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6322 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6323
6324 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6325 ".", "_", and "~".
6326
6327 Example:
6328 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6329 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6330 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6331 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6332
6333 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6334 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6335
6336 Example:
6337 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6338 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6339
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006340 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006341 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006342
6343 Example:
6344 - /%6f -> /%6F
6345 - /%zz -> /%zz
6346
6347 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6348 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6349
6350 Example:
6351 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6352
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006353 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006354 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6355 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6356
6357 Example:
6358 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6359 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6360 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006362http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006364 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6365 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6366 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6367 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6368 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006370http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006372 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6373 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6374 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6375 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006377http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6378 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006379
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006380 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006381 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6382 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6383 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6384 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6385 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006386
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006387 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6388 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6389 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6390 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6391 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006392
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006393 Example:
6394 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6395
6396 # applied to:
6397 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6398
6399 # outputs:
6400 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6401
6402 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006403
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006404 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6405
6406 # applied to:
6407 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006408
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006409 # outputs:
6410 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006411
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006412http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6413 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6414
6415 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6416 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006417 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6418 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6419 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006420
6421 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6422 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6423 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6424
6425 Example:
6426 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6427 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6428
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006429 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6430 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6431 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6432 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6433
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006434http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6435 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6436
6437 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6438 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6439 query-string are replaced.
6440
6441 Example:
6442 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6443 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6444
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006445http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6447
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006448 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6449 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6450 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6451 against.
6452
6453 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6454 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6455 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006456
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006457 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6458 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6459 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6460 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6461 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6462 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6463 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6464 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6465 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006466 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6467 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006468
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006469 Example:
6470 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6471 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006472
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006473 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6474 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006475
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006476http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6477 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006478
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006479 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6480 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6481 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6482 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006483
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006484 Example:
6485 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006486
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006487 # applied to:
6488 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006489
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006490 # outputs:
6491 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006492
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006493http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6494 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6495 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006496 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006497 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6498
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006499 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006500 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6501 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006502 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006503 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006504 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006505 are followed to create the response :
6506
6507 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6508 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6509 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6510 ignored.
6511
6512 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6513 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006514 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006515 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6516 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006517
6518 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6519 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6520 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006521 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006522 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006523
6524 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6525 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6526 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006527 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006528 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006529 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006530
6531 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6532 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6533 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6534 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6535 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6536 as a raw content.
6537
6538 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6539 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6540 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6541 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6542 considered as a raw string.
6543
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006544 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006545 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6546 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6547 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6548
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006549 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6550 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006551 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006552
6553 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6554
6555 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006556 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006557 if { path /ping }
6558
6559 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6560 if { path /favicon.ico }
6561
6562 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6563 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6564 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006566http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6567http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006569 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6570 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6571 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006572
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006573http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6574 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006575
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006576 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6577 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6578 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6579 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006581http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006583 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6584 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6585 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6586 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6587 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006589 Arguments:
6590 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6591 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006593 Example:
6594 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6595 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006597 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6598 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006600http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006602 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6603 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6604 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006606 Arguments:
6607 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6608 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006609
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006610 Example:
6611 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6612 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6615 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6616 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006618http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6621 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6622 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6623 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6624 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626 Example:
6627 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6628 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6629 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6630 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6631 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6632 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6633 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6634 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6635 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006637http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6640 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6641 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6642 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6643 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006645http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6646 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006648 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6649 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6650 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6651 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6652 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6653 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6654 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6655 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6656 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006658http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006660 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6661 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6662 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6663 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6664 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6665 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6666 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006668http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006670 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6671 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6672 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6677 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6678 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6679 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6680 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6681 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6682 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6683 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006685http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006687 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6688 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6689 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6690 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6691 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6692 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006694 Example :
6695 # prepend the host name before the path
6696 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006697
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006698http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6699
6700 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6701 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6702 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006704http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006706 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6707 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6708 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6709 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6710 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006712http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006714 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6715 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6716 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6717 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6718 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6719 values have higher priority.
6720 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6721 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6722 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6723 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6724 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006726http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006727
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006728 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6729 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6730 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6731 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6732 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6733 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6734 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006736 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006737
6738 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006739 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6740 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006742http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6743 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6744 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6745 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006746 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6747 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006748
6749 Arguments :
6750 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6751 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006752
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006753 See also "option forwardfor".
6754
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006755 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006756 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6757 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6758
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006759 # After the masking this will track connections
6760 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6761 http-request track-sc0 src
6762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006763 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6764 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6765
6766http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6767
6768 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6769 expression.
6770
6771 Arguments:
6772 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6773 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006774
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006775 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006776 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6777 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6778
6779 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6780 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6781 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6782
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006783http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006784 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6785
6786 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6787 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6788 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6789 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6790 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6791
6792 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6793 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6794 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6795 results.
6796
6797 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006798 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6799 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006800
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006801http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6802
6803 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6804 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6805 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6806 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6807 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6808 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6809 information from the request.
6810
6811 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6812
6813http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6814
6815 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6816 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6817 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6818 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6819 path and the query string.
6820 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6821
6822http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6823
6824 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6825 inline.
6826
6827 Arguments:
6828 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6829 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6830 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6831 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6832 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6833 (request and response)
6834 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6835 processing
6836 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6837 processing
6838 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6839 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6840 and '_'.
6841
6842 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6843 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006844
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006845 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006846 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006848http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6849 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006850
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006851 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6852 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6853 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6854 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6855 agent name must be used.
6856
6857 Arguments:
6858 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6859
6860 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6861 configuration.
6862
6863http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6864
6865 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6866 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6867 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6868 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6869 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6870 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6871 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6872 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6873 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6874 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6875 action.
6876 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6877 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6878 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6879 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6880 you fully understand how it works.
6881
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006882http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6883
6884 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6885 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6886 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6887 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6888 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006889 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006890 processing.
6891
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006892 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006893 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6894 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6895 rules evaluation.
6896
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006897http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6898http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6899 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6900 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6901 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6902 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006903
6904 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6905 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6906 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006907 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6908 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6909 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6910 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6911 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6912 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006913 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006914 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6915 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6916 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006917 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006918 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6919 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6920 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6921 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6922 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006923
6924http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6925http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6926http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6927
6928 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6929 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6930 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6931 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006932 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006933 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6934 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6935 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6936 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6937 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6938 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6939 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6940
6941 Arguments :
6942 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6943 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6944 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6945 select which table entry to update the counters.
6946
6947 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6948 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6949 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6950 that table until the session ends.
6951
6952 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6953 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6954 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6955 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6956 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6957 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6958 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6959 useful information.
6960
6961 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6962 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6963 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6964 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6965 checks that make use of it.
6966
6967http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6968
6969 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006970
6971 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006972 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006973
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006974http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6975
6976 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6977 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6978 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6979 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6980 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6981 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6982
6983 Arguments :
6984 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6985
6986 Example:
6987 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6988
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006989http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6990 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6991
6992 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6993 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6994 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6995 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6996 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6997 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6998 http-buffer-request".
6999
7000 Arguments :
7001
7002 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7003 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7004
7005 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007006 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007007 bytes.
7008
7009 Example:
7010 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7011
7012 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007014http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007016 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7017 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7018 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007019
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007021http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007022 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7023
7024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7025 no | yes | yes | yes
7026
7027 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7028 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7029 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7030 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7031 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7032 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007034 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7035 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007037 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007039 Example:
7040 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007042 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007044 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7045 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007047 Example:
7048 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007050 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7053 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007055 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7056 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007058http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007060 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7061 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7062 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7063 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7064 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7065 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7066 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7067 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007069http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007071 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7072 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7073 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7074 example, or to pass some internal information.
7075 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7076 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7077 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007078
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007079http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007081 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7082 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007083
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007084http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007085
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007086 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007088http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007090 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7091 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7092 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7093 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7094 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7095 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7096 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007098 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7099 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7100 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7101 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7102 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007103
7104 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7105 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7106 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7107 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007108
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007109http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007111 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7112 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7113 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7114 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7115 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7116 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007117
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007118http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007119
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007120 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7121 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7122 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7123 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7124 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007125
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007126http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007128 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7129 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7130 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7131 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7132 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7133 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007134
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007135http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7136http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7137 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7138 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7139 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7140 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007141
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007142 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7143 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7144 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007145 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007146 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7147 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7148 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007149 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007150 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007152http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007154 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7155 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7156 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7157 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7158 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7159 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007161http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7162 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007163
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007164 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7165 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007167 Example:
7168 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007170 # applied to:
7171 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007173 # outputs:
7174 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007176 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007178http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7179 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007180
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007181 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007182 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007184 Example:
7185 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007187 # applied to:
7188 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007190 # outputs:
7191 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007192
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007193http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7194 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7195 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007196 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007197 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7198
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007199 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007200 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7201 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007202 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007203 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007204 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007205 are followed to create the response :
7206
7207 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7208 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7209 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7210 ignored.
7211
7212 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7213 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007214 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007215 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7216 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007217
7218 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7219 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7220 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007221 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007222 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007223
7224 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7225 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7226 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007227 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007228 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007229 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007230
7231 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7232 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7233 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7234 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7235 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7236 as a raw content.
7237
7238 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7239 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7240 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7241 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7242 considered as a raw string.
7243
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007244 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7245 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7246 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7247 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7248
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007249 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7250 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007251 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007252
7253 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7254
7255 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007256 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007257 if { status eq 404 }
7258
7259 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7260 string "This is the end !" \
7261 if { status eq 500 }
7262
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007263http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7264http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007265
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007266 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7267 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7268 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007269
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007270http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7271 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007272
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007273 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7274 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7275 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7276 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007277
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007278http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7279 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007280
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007281 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7282 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7283 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7284 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7285 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007287 Arguments:
7288 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007289
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007290 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7291 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007292
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007293http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007294
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007295 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7296 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7297 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007298
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007299http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7300
7301 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7302 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7303 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7304 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7305 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7306
7307http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7308
7309 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7310 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7311 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7312 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7313 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7314 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7315 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7316 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7317 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7318
7319http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7320
7321 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7322 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7323 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7324 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7325 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7326 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7327 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7328
7329http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7330
7331 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7332 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7333 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7334 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7335 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7336 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7337 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7338 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7339
7340http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7341 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7342
7343 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7344 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7345 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7346 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007347
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007348 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007349 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7350 http-response set-status 431
7351 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7352 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007353
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007354http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007355
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007356 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7357 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7358 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7359 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7360 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7361 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7362 based on some information from the request.
7363
7364 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7365
7366http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7367
7368 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7369 inline.
7370
7371 Arguments:
7372 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7373 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7374 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7375 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7376 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7377 (request and response)
7378 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7379 processing
7380 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7381 processing
7382 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7383 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7384 and '_'.
7385
7386 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7387 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007388
7389 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007390 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007391
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007392http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007393
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007394 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7395 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7396 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7397 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7398 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7399 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7400 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7401 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7402 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7403 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7404 action.
7405 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7406 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7407 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7408 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7409 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007410
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007411http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7412
7413 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7414 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7415 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7416 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7417 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007418 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007419 processing.
7420
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007421 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007422 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007423 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007424 rules evaluation.
7425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007426http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7427http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7428http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007429
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007430 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7431 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7432 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7433 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7434 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007435 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007436
7437http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7438
7439 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7440 about <var-name>.
7441
7442 Example:
7443 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7444
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007445http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7447
7448 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7449 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7450 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7451 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7452 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7453 buffer is full.
7454
7455 Arguments :
7456
7457 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7458 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7459
7460 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007461 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007462 bytes.
7463
7464 Example:
7465 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007466
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007467http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7468 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7469
7470 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7471 yes | no | yes | yes
7472
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007473 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007474 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7475 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7476 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007477
7478 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7479
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007480 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7481 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7482 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7483 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7484 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7485 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7486 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007487 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007488 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7489 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007490
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007491 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7492 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7493 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7494 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7495 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7496 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7497 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007498 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7499 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7500 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7501 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7502 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7503 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007504
7505 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7506 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7507 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7508 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7509 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7510 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7511 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7512 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007513 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007514 downsides of rare connection failures.
7515
7516 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7517 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7518 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7519 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7520 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7521 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007522 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007523 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7524 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7525 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7526 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7527 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7528
7529 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007530 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7531 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7532 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7533 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007534
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007535 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7536 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007537
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007538 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007539
7540 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7541 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7542 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7543
7544 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7545
7546
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007547http-send-name-header [<header>]
7548 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007549 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7550 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007551 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007552 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7553
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007554 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7555 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7556 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7557 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7558 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7559 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7560 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7561 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7562 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7563 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7564 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7565 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7566 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7567 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7568 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7569 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007570
7571 See also : "server"
7572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007573id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007574 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7576 no | yes | yes | yes
7577 Arguments : none
7578
7579 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7580 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7581 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007582
7583
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007584ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7585 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7586 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007587 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007588
7589 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7590 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7591 and running).
7592
7593 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7594 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7595 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007596 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007597 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7598
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007599 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7600 "unless" condition is met.
7601
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007602 Example:
7603 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7604 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7605 ignore-persist if url_static
7606
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007607 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7608
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007609load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7610 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7612 yes | no | yes | yes
7613
7614 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7615 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7616 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007617 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007618 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007619 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7620 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7621 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7622
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007623 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007624 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007625 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007626
7627 Arguments:
7628 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7629 named "server-state-file".
7630
7631 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7632 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7633 name is used as a file name.
7634
7635 none don't load any stat for this backend
7636
7637 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007638 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7639 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7640 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007641 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007642 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007643
7644 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7645 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7646
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007647 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007648
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007649 global
7650 stats socket /tmp/socket
7651 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007652
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007653 defaults
7654 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007655
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007656 backend bk
7657 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7658 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007659
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007660
7661 Then one can run :
7662
7663 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7664
7665 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7666
7667 1
7668 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7669 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7670 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7671
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007672 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007673
7674 global
7675 stats socket /tmp/socket
7676 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7677
7678 defaults
7679 load-server-state-from-file local
7680
7681 backend bk
7682 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7683 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7684
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007685
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007686 Then one can run :
7687
7688 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7689
7690 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7691
7692 1
7693 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7694 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7695 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7696
7697 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7698 "show servers state"
7699
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007701log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007702log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007703 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007704no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007705 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7707 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007708
7709 Prefix :
7710 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7711 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7712 prefix does not allow arguments.
7713
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007714 Arguments :
7715 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7716 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7717 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7718 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7719 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7720 parameter.
7721
7722 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7723 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7724
7725 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7726 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7727 standard syslog port).
7728
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007729 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7730 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7731 standard syslog port).
7732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007733 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7734 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7735 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007736 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007737
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007738 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7739 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7740 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7741 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7742 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7743 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7744 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7745 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7746 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7747 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7748 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7749 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007750 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007751 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7752 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7753 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007754 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7755 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007756
7757 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7758 and "fd@2", see above.
7759
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007760 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7761 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7762 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7763 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7764 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7765 having the logs instantly available.
7766
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007767 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7768 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7769 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7770
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007771 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7772 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007773
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007774 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7775 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7776 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7777 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7778 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7779 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7780 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7781 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7782 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7783 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007784 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007785
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007786 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7787 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7788 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7789 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7790 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7791
7792 <sample_size>
7793 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7794 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7795 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7796 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7797 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7798
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007799 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7800 one of the following :
7801
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007802 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7803 field is stripped. This is the default.
7804 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7805 rfc3164.
7806
7807 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007808 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7809
7810 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7811 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7812
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007813 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7814 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7815 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7816 designed to be used with a local log server.
7817
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007818 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7819 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7820 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7821 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7822 systemd logger consumes.
7823
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007824 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7825 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7826 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7827 used with a local log server.
7828
7829 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7830 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7831 designed to be used with a local log server.
7832
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007833 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7834 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7835 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7836 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7837
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007838 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7839
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007840 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7841 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7842 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7843
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007844 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7845 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7846 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7847 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007848
7849 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7850 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7851 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007852 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7853 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7854 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7855 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7856 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007857
7858 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7859
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007860 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7861 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7862 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007863
7864 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7865 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7866 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7867 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7868
7869 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7870 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007871
7872 Example :
7873 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007874 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7875 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7876 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007877 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007878 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7879 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007880 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007881
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007882
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007883log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007884 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7885 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7886 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007887
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007888 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7889 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7890 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7891 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7892 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007893
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007894 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7895 "option httplog" directives.
7896
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007897log-format-sd <string>
7898 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7899 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7900 yes | yes | yes | no
7901
7902 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7903 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7904 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7905 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7906 which covers the log format string in depth.
7907
7908 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7909 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7910
7911 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7912 log format to "rfc5424".
7913
7914 Example :
7915 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7916
7917
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007918log-tag <string>
7919 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7920 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7921 yes | yes | yes | yes
7922
7923 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7924 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007925 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007926 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7927 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7928 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7929 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7930 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7931 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007932
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007933max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7934 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7935 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7936 yes | no | yes | yes
7937
7938 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7939 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7940 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7941 servers.
7942
7943 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007944 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007945 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7946 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7947 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007948 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007949 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7950 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7951 picking a different server.
7952
7953 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7954 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7955 even if they have to be queued.
7956
7957 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7958 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7959
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007960max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7961 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7962 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7963 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007964
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007965maxconn <conns>
7966 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7968 yes | yes | yes | no
7969 Arguments :
7970 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7971 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7972 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7973 closes.
7974
7975 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007976 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007977 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7978 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007979 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7980 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7981 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7982 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007983
7984 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7985 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7986 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7987
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007988 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7989 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007990
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007991 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7992
7993
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007994mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007995 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7997 yes | yes | yes | yes
7998 Arguments :
7999 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8000 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8001 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8002 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8003
8004 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8005 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8006 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8007 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8008 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8009
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008010 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8011 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8012 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008013
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008014 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008015 defaults http_instances
8016 mode http
8017
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008018
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008019monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008020 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8022 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008023 Arguments :
8024 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8025 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008026 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008027 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8028 backend and its backup.
8029
8030 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8031 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8032 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8033 servers in a list of backends.
8034
8035 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8036 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8037 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008038 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008039 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8040 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008041 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008042 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8043 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008044
8045 Example:
8046 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008047 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008048 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8049 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8050 monitor-uri /site_alive
8051 monitor fail if site_dead
8052
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008053 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008054
8055
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008056monitor-uri <uri>
8057 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8059 yes | yes | yes | no
8060 Arguments :
8061 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8062 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8063
8064 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8065 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8066 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8067 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8068 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8069 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8070 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8071 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8072
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008073 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008074 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8075 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8076 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8077 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8078 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8079 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008080
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008081 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8082 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8083 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8084 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8085
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008086 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008087 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008088 frontend www
8089 mode http
8090 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8091
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008092 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008093
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008094
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008095option abortonclose
8096no option abortonclose
8097 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8099 yes | no | yes | yes
8100 Arguments : none
8101
8102 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8103 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8104 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8105 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008106 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008107 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8108 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8109 encountered while delivering the response.
8110
8111 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8112 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8113 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8114 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8115 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8116 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008117 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008118 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008119 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008120 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8121 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8122 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8123
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008124 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8125 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008126 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8127 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8128 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8129 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8130 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8131 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008132 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008133
8134 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8135 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8136
8137 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8138
8139
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008140option accept-invalid-http-request
8141no option accept-invalid-http-request
8142 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8144 yes | yes | yes | no
8145 Arguments : none
8146
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008147 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008148 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008149 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008150 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8151 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8152 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8153 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8154 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008155 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8156 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8157 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8158 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008159 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008160 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008161 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8162 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8163 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008164
8165 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8166 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8167 been confirmed.
8168
8169 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8170 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008171 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8172 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008173 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8174
8175 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8176 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8177
8178 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8179 stats socket.
8180
8181
8182option accept-invalid-http-response
8183no option accept-invalid-http-response
8184 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8186 yes | no | yes | yes
8187 Arguments : none
8188
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008189 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008190 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008191 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008192 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8193 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8194 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8195 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8196 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008197 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8198 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8199 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008200
8201 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8202 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8203 been confirmed.
8204
8205 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8206 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8207 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8208 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8209
8210 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8211 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8212
8213 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8214 stats socket.
8215
8216
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008217option allbackups
8218no option allbackups
8219 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8221 yes | no | yes | yes
8222 Arguments : none
8223
8224 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8225 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8226 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8227 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8228 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8229 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8230 order between the backup servers anymore.
8231
8232 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8233 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8234
8235 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8236 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8237
8238
8239option checkcache
8240no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008241 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8243 yes | no | yes | yes
8244 Arguments : none
8245
8246 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8247 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008248 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008249 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8250 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008251 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008252
8253 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008254 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008255 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008256 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8257 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008258 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008259 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008260 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8261 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008262 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008263 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8264 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008265 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008266 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8267 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8268 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8269 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8270 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8271 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8272 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8273 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8274 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8275
8276 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008277 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8278 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8279 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8280 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008281
8282 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8283 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008284 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008285 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008286
8287 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8288 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8289
8290
8291option clitcpka
8292no option clitcpka
8293 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8295 yes | yes | yes | no
8296 Arguments : none
8297
8298 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8299 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008300 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008301 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8302
8303 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8304 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8305 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8306 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8307
8308 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8309 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8310 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8311 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8312 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8313
8314 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8315
8316 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8317 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8318 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8319
8320 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8321 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8322
8323 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8324
8325
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008326option contstats
8327 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8329 yes | yes | yes | no
8330 Arguments : none
8331
8332 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8333 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8334 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008335 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008336 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8337 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8338 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8339 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8340 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008341
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008342option disable-h2-upgrade
8343no option disable-h2-upgrade
8344 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8345 connection.
8346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8347 yes | yes | yes | no
8348 Arguments : none
8349
8350 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8351 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8352 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8353 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008354 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8355 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8356 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8357 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8358 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8359 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008360
8361 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8362 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008363
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008364option dontlog-normal
8365no option dontlog-normal
8366 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8368 yes | yes | yes | no
8369 Arguments : none
8370
8371 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8372 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8373 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8374 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8375 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8376 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8377 logged.
8378
8379 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8380 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8381 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008383 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008384 logging.
8385
8386
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008387option dontlognull
8388no option dontlognull
8389 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8391 yes | yes | yes | no
8392 Arguments : none
8393
8394 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8395 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8396 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8397 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8398 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8399 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008400 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8401 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8402 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008403
8404 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008405 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008406 would not be logged.
8407
8408 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8409 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8410
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008411 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008412 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008413
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008414
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008415option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008416 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8418 yes | yes | yes | yes
8419 Arguments :
8420 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8421 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008422 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008423 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008424
8425 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8426 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8427 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8428 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8429 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8430 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8431 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008432 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8433 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8434 possible that the client has already brought one.
8435
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008436 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008437 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008438 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008439 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008440 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008441 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008442
8443 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8444 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8445 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8446 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8447 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8448 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008449 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008450
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008451 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8452 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008453 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008454 are under the control of the end-user.
8455
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008456 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008457 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8458 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008459 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8460 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8461 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008462
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008463 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008464 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8465 frontend www
8466 mode http
8467 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8468
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008469 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8470 backend www
8471 mode http
8472 option forwardfor header X-Client
8473
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008474 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008475 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008476
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008477
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008478option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8479no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8480 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8482 yes | yes | yes | no
8483 Arguments : none
8484
8485 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8486 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8487 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8488 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8489 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8490 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8491 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8492
8493 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8494 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8495 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8496 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8497 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8498 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8499 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8500 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8501 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8502 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8503
8504 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8505
8506 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8507 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8508
8509 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8510 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8511
8512
8513option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8514no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8515 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8517 yes | no | yes | yes
8518 Arguments : none
8519
8520 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8521 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8522 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8523 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8524 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8525 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8526 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8527
8528 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8529 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8530 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8531 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8532 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8533 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8534 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8535 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8536 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8537 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8538
8539 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8540
8541 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8542 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8543
8544 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8545 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8546
8547
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008548option http-buffer-request
8549no option http-buffer-request
8550 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8552 yes | yes | yes | yes
8553 Arguments : none
8554
8555 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8556 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8557 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8558 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8559 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8560 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008561 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8562 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8563 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8564 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008565
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008566 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8567 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008568
8569
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008570option http-ignore-probes
8571no option http-ignore-probes
8572 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8574 yes | yes | yes | no
8575 Arguments : none
8576
8577 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8578 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8579 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8580 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8581 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8582 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8583 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8584 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8585 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008586 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8587 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008588 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8589
8590 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8591 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8592 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8593 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8594 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8595 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8596 are often the only way to detect them.
8597
8598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8600
8601 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8602
8603
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008604option http-keep-alive
8605no option http-keep-alive
8606 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8608 yes | yes | yes | yes
8609 Arguments : none
8610
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008611 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8612 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008613 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8614 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008615 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8616 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8617 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008618
8619 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8620 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008621 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8622 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8623 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8624 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8625 situations where this option may be useful :
8626
8627 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008628 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008629
8630 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8631 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8632
8633 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8634 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8635 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8636 request.
8637
8638 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8639 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008640 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8641 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8642 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008643
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008644 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8645 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8646 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8647 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8648 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8649 not set.
8650
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008651 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8652 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8653 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008654
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008655 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008656 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008657 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008658
8659
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008660option http-no-delay
8661no option http-no-delay
8662 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8664 yes | yes | yes | yes
8665 Arguments : none
8666
8667 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8668 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8669 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8670 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8671 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8672 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8673 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008674 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008675 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8676 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8677 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8678 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8679 affected.
8680
8681 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8682 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8683 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8684 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8685 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8686 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8687 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8688 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8689 latency environments.
8690
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008691 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8692
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008693
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008694option http-pretend-keepalive
8695no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008696 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008698 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008699 Arguments : none
8700
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008701 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008702 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8703 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8704 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008705 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008706 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8707 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8708 consider the response complete.
8709
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008710 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008711 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008712 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008713 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008714 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008715 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8716
8717 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8718 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8719 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8720 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008721 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8722 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008723 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8724
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008725 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8726 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8727 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8728 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8729 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8730 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008731
8732 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8733 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8734
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008735 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008736 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008737
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008738option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8739 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8740 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8742 yes | yes | yes | yes
8743 Arguments :
8744 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8745 with no FastCGI application configured.
8746
8747 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8748 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8749 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8750
8751 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8752 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8753
8754 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8755 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8756 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8757 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8758 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8759 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8760 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8761 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8762
8763 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8764 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008765
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008766option http-server-close
8767no option http-server-close
8768 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8770 yes | yes | yes | yes
8771 Arguments : none
8772
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008773 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8774 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8775 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8776 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008777 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8778 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8779 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8780 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8781 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8782 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8783 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8784 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8785 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8786 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8787 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008788
8789 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8790 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8791 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8792 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008793 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8794 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008795
8796 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8797 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008798 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8799 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8800 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008801
8802 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8803 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8804
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008805 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8806 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008807
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008808option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008809no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008810 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8812 yes | yes | yes | no
8813 Arguments : none
8814
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008815 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008816 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8817 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8818 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8819 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8820 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008821 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008822
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008823 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008824 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008825 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8826 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8827 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008828
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008829 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8830 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8831 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8832 front of an existing proxy.
8833
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008834 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8835
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008836 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008837
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008838option httpchk
8839option httpchk <uri>
8840option httpchk <method> <uri>
8841option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008842 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8844 yes | no | yes | yes
8845 Arguments :
8846 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8847 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8848 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8849 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8850 ones.
8851
8852 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8853 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8854 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8855
8856 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8857 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8858 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008859 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008860
8861 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8862 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8863 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8864 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8865 the lack of any response.
8866
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008867 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8868 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8869 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8870 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8871
8872 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8873 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8874 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008875
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008876 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8877 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008878 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008879 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008880 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008881
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008882 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8883 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8884 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8885 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8886
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008887 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008888 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8889 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8890 backend https_relay
8891 mode tcp
8892 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8893 http-check send hdr Host www
8894 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008895
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008896 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8897 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8898 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008899
8900
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008901option httpclose
8902no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008903 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8905 yes | yes | yes | yes
8906 Arguments : none
8907
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008908 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8909 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8910 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8911 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008912 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008913
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008914 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8915 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008916 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008917 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8918 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008919
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008920 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8921 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8922 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008923
8924 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8925 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008926 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8927 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8928 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008929
8930 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8931 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8932
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008933 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008934
8935
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008936option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008937 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008939 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008940 Arguments :
8941 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8942 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8943 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008944 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008945 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008946
8947 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8948 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8949 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8950 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8951 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8952 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8953 ports.
8954
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008955 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8956 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008957
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008958 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008960 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008961
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008962
8963option http_proxy
8964no option http_proxy
8965 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8967 yes | yes | yes | yes
8968 Arguments : none
8969
8970 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8971 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8972 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8973 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8974 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8975
8976 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8977 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008978 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8979 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008980
8981 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8982 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8983
8984 Example :
8985 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8986 backend direct_forward
8987 option httpclose
8988 option http_proxy
8989
8990 See also : "option httpclose"
8991
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008992
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008993option independent-streams
8994no option independent-streams
8995 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8997 yes | yes | yes | yes
8998 Arguments : none
8999
9000 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9001 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9002 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9003 receive data or not.
9004
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009005 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009006 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9007 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9008 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9009 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9010 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9011 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9012 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9013 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9014 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9015 socket buffers.
9016
9017 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9018 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9019 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9020 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9021 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9022
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009023 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009024
9025
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009026option ldap-check
9027 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9029 yes | no | yes | yes
9030 Arguments : none
9031
9032 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9033 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9034 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9035 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9036
9037 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9038 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9039
9040 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9041 configure it.
9042
9043 Example :
9044 option ldap-check
9045
9046 See also : "option httpchk"
9047
9048
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009049option external-check
9050 Use external processes for server health checks
9051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9052 yes | no | yes | yes
9053
9054 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9055 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9056 command".
9057
9058 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9059
9060 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9061
9062
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009063option idle-close-on-response
9064no option idle-close-on-response
9065 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9067 yes | yes | yes | no
9068 Arguments : none
9069
9070 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9071 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9072 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9073 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9074 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9075 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9076 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9077 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9078 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9079
9080 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9081 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9082
9083 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9084 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9085 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9086 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9087
9088 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9089 "hard-stop-after"
9090
9091
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009092option log-health-checks
9093no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009094 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9096 yes | no | yes | yes
9097 Arguments : none
9098
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009099 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9100 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9101 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009102
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009103 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9104 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9105 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9106 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9107 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9108
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009109 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009110 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009111
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009112 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9113 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9114 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009115
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009116
9117option log-separate-errors
9118no option log-separate-errors
9119 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9121 yes | yes | yes | no
9122 Arguments : none
9123
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009124 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009125 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9126 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9127 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9128 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9129 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9130 provides very important information.
9131
9132 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9133 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9134 error logs.
9135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009136 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009137 logging.
9138
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009139
9140option logasap
9141no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009142 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9144 yes | yes | yes | no
9145 Arguments : none
9146
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009147 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9148 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9149 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9150 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9151
9152 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9153 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9154 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9155 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9156 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009157 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009158 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9159 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9160 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9161 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009162 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009163
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009164 Examples :
9165 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9166 mode http
9167 option httplog
9168 option logasap
9169 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9170
9171 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9172 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9173 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9174 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009176 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009177 logging.
9178
9179
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009180option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009181 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9183 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009184 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009185 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9186 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009187 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9188 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009189
9190 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9191 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009192 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009193 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009194 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9195 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9196 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009197
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009198 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9199 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9200 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009201
9202 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009203 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009204 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9205 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9206 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9207 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9208 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9209 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9210 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9211
9212 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9213 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009214
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009215 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009216
9217 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9218 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9219 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9220 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009221 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009222 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009223
9224 See also: "option httpchk"
9225
9226
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009227option nolinger
9228no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009229 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009230 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9231 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009232 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009233
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009234 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009235 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9236 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9237 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9238 connections.
9239
9240 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9241 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009242 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9243 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9244 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9245 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9246 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9247 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9248 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9249 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9250 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9251 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9252 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9253 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9254 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009255
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009256 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9257 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9258 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9259 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9260 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009261
9262 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9263 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009264 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009265 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009266 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009267
9268 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9269 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9270
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009271 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9272 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009273
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009274option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9275 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9277 yes | yes | yes | yes
9278 Arguments :
9279 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9280 matching <network>
9281 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9282 header name.
9283
9284 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9285 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9286 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9287 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9288 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9289 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9290 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9291 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9292 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9293 possible that the client has already brought one.
9294
9295 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9296 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9297 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9298 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9299 header and requires different one.
9300
9301 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9302 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9303 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009304 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9305 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9306 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9307 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9308 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009309
9310 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9311 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9312 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9313 both are defined.
9314
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009315 Examples :
9316 # Original Destination address
9317 frontend www
9318 mode http
9319 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9320
9321 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9322 backend www
9323 mode http
9324 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9325
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009326 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009327
9328
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009329option persist
9330no option persist
9331 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9332 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9333 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009334 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009335
9336 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9337 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9338 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9339 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9340 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9341 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9342 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9343 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9344 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9345 redirected to another valid server.
9346
9347 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9348 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9349
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009350 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009351
9352
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009353option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9354 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9356 yes | no | yes | yes
9357 Arguments :
9358 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9359 PostgreSQL server.
9360
9361 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9362 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9363 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9364 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9365
9366 See also: "option httpchk"
9367
9368
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009369option prefer-last-server
9370no option prefer-last-server
9371 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9372 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9373 yes | no | yes | yes
9374 Arguments : none
9375
9376 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009377 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009378 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9379 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009380 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009381 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009382 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009383 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9384 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009385 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009386 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009387 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9388 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9389 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009390 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9391 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9392 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009393
9394 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9395 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9396
9397 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9398
9399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009400option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009401option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009402no option redispatch
9403 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9404 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9405 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009406 Arguments :
9407 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9408 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9409 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009410 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009411 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009412 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009413 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9414 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9415 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009417
9418 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9419 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9420 be able to access the service anymore.
9421
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009422 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9423 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009424
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009425 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9426 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9427 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9428 following order:
9429
9430 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9431
9432 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9433 list, or
9434
9435 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9436
9437 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9438 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9439
9440 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9441 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9442 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9443 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9444
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009445 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009446 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9447 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009449 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9450 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9451
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009452 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009453
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009454
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009455option redis-check
9456 Use redis health checks for server testing
9457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9458 yes | no | yes | yes
9459 Arguments : none
9460
9461 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9462 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9463 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9464 find the "+PONG" response message.
9465
9466 Example :
9467 option redis-check
9468
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009469 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009470
9471
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009472option smtpchk
9473option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9474 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9476 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009477 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009478 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009479 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009480 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9481
9482 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9483 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9484 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9485
9486 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9487 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9488 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9489 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9490 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9491 dead server.
9492
9493 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9494 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009495 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009496 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9497
9498 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9499 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9500 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9501 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009502 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009503
9504 Example :
9505 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9506
9507 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009510option socket-stats
9511no option socket-stats
9512
9513 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9515 yes | yes | yes | no
9516
9517 Arguments : none
9518
9519
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009520option splice-auto
9521no option splice-auto
9522 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9524 yes | yes | yes | yes
9525 Arguments : none
9526
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009527 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009528 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009529 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009530 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009531 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009532 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9533 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9534 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9535 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9536
9537 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9538 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9539 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9540 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9541 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9542 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9543 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9544 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9545 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9546 keyword.
9547
9548 Example :
9549 option splice-auto
9550
9551 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9552 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9553
9554 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9555 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9556
9557
9558option splice-request
9559no option splice-request
9560 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9562 yes | yes | yes | yes
9563 Arguments : none
9564
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009565 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009566 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009567 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9568 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9569 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9570 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9571
9572 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9573
9574 Example :
9575 option splice-request
9576
9577 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9578 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9579
9580 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9581 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9582
9583
9584option splice-response
9585no option splice-response
9586 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9588 yes | yes | yes | yes
9589 Arguments : none
9590
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009591 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009592 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009593 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9594 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9595 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9596 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9597
9598 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9599
9600 Example :
9601 option splice-response
9602
9603 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9604 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9605
9606 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9607 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9608
9609
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009610option spop-check
9611 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9613 no | no | no | yes
9614 Arguments : none
9615
9616 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9617 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9618 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9619 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9620
9621 Example :
9622 option spop-check
9623
9624 See also : "option httpchk"
9625
9626
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009627option srvtcpka
9628no option srvtcpka
9629 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9631 yes | no | yes | yes
9632 Arguments : none
9633
9634 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9635 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009636 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009637 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9638
9639 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9640 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9641 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9642 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9643
9644 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9645 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9646 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9647 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9648 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9649
9650 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9651
9652 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9653 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9654 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9655
9656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9658
9659 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9660
9661
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009662option ssl-hello-chk
9663 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9665 yes | no | yes | yes
9666 Arguments : none
9667
9668 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9669 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9670 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9671 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9672 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9673 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9674 hello message.
9675
9676 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9677 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9678 messages, which is appreciable.
9679
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009680 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009681 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9682 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009683
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009684 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9685
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009686
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009687option tcp-check
9688 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9689 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9690 yes | no | yes | yes
9691
9692 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9693 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9694
9695 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9696 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9697 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9698
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009699 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009700 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9701 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9702 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9703 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9704 only.
9705
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009706 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009707 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009708 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9709 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9710 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9711
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009712 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009713 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9714 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009715 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009716 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9717 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9718 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9719 the respective protocols.
9720 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009721 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009722
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009723 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009724
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009725 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9726 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9727 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9728 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009729
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009730 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9731 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9732 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009733
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009734
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009735 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009736 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009737 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009738 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009739
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009740 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009741 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009742 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009743
9744 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9745 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009746 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009747 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009748 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009749 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009750 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009751 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009752 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9753 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009754 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009755 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9756 tcp-check expect string +OK
9757
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009758 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009759 (send many headers before analyzing)
9760 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009761 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009762 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9763 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9764 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9765 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009766 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009767
9768
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009769 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009770
9771
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009772option tcp-smart-accept
9773no option tcp-smart-accept
9774 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9776 yes | yes | yes | no
9777 Arguments : none
9778
9779 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9780 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9781 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9782 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9783 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9784 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9785
9786 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9787 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9788 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9789 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9790
9791 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9792 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9793 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009794 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009795
9796 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9797 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9798 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9799
9800 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9801 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9802 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9803
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009804 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9805
9806
9807option tcp-smart-connect
9808no option tcp-smart-connect
9809 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9811 yes | no | yes | yes
9812 Arguments : none
9813
9814 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9815 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9816 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9817 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9818 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9819
9820 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9821 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9822 complex.
9823
9824 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9825 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9826 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9827
9828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9830
9831 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9832
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009833
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009834option tcpka
9835 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9837 yes | yes | yes | yes
9838 Arguments : none
9839
9840 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9841 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009842 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009843 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9844
9845 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9846 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9847 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9848 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9849
9850 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9851 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9852 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9853 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9854 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9855
9856 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9857
9858 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9859 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9860 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9861 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9862 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9863 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9864 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9865 backends.
9866
9867 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9868
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009869
9870option tcplog
9871 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009873 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009874 Arguments : none
9875
9876 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9877 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9878 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9879 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9880 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9881 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9882 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9883 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9884
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009885 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009887 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009888
9889
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009890option transparent
9891no option transparent
9892 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009894 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009895 Arguments : none
9896
9897 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9898 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9899 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9900 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9901 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9902 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9903 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9904 appropriate server.
9905
9906 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9907 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9908
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009909 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009910 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009911
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009912
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009913external-check command <command>
9914 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9916 yes | no | yes | yes
9917
9918 Arguments :
9919 <command> is the external command to run
9920
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009921 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9922
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009923 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009924
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009925 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9926 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9927 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9928 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9929 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9930 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009931
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009932 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9933
9934 Environment variables :
9935 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9936 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9937
9938 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9939
9940 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9941
9942 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9943 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9944 for a UNIX socket).
9945
9946 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9947
9948 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9949
9950 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9951
9952 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9953
9954 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9955
9956 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9957 socket).
9958
9959 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9960 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9961
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009962 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9963
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009964 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9965 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9966 failed.
9967
9968 Example :
9969 external-check command /bin/true
9970
9971 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9972
9973
9974external-check path <path>
9975 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9977 yes | no | yes | yes
9978
9979 Arguments :
9980 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9981
9982 The default path is "".
9983
9984 Example :
9985 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9986
9987 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9988 "external-check command"
9989
9990
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009991persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009992persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009993 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9995 yes | no | yes | yes
9996 Arguments :
9997 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009998 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9999 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010000
10001 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10002 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010003 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010004 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10005 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10006 forwarded to this server.
10007
10008 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10009 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10010 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010011 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010012 a single "listen" section.
10013
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010014 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10015 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10016 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10017
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010018 Example :
10019 listen tse-farm
10020 bind :3389
10021 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10022 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10023 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10024 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10025 persist rdp-cookie
10026 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010027 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010028 balance rdp-cookie
10029 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10030 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10031
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010032 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010033
10034
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010035rate-limit sessions <rate>
10036 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10038 yes | yes | yes | no
10039 Arguments :
10040 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10041 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10042
10043 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10044 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10045 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010046 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010047 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10048 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10049
10050 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10051 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10052 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10053 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10054
10055 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10056 listen smtp
10057 mode tcp
10058 bind :25
10059 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010060 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010061
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010062 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10063 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10064 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010065
10066 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10067
10068
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010069redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10070redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10071redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010072 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10074 no | yes | yes | yes
10075
10076 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010077 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010078
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010079 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010080 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010081 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10082 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10083 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010084
10085 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10086 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10087 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10088 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10089 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010090 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10091 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10092 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10093 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010094
10095 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10096 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10097 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10098 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10099 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10100 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010101 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010102 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010103 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10104 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10105 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010106
10107 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010108 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10109 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10110 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010111 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010112 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10113 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10114 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10115 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010116
10117 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010118 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010119
10120 - "drop-query"
10121 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10122 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10123 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10124 with a location-type redirect.
10125
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010126 - "append-slash"
10127 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10128 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10129 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10130 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10131
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010132 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10133 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10134 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10135 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10136 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10137 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10138 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10139
10140 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10141 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10142 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10143 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10144 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10145 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10146 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010147
10148 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10149 acl clear dst_port 80
10150 acl secure dst_port 8080
10151 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010152 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010153 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010154 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10155
10156 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010157 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10158 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10159 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010160 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010161
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010162 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10163 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10164 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10165
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010166 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010167 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010168
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010169 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010170 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10171 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10172 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010174 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010175
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010176
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010177retries <value>
10178 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10179 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10180 yes | no | yes | yes
10181 Arguments :
10182 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10183 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10184 default value is 3.
10185
10186 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10187 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10188 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10189
10190 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010191 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10192 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010193
10194 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10195 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10196
10197 See also : "option redispatch"
10198
10199
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010200retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010201 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10202 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10203 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10205 yes | no | yes | yes
10206 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010207 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10208 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10209 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10210 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10211 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010212
10213 none never retry
10214
10215 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10216 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10217
10218 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10219 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10220 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10221 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10222 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10223 processing the request.
10224
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010225 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10226 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10227 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10228 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10229 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10230 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10231 overflow attack for example).
10232
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010233 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10234 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10235 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10236 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10237 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10238 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10239 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10240 amplify denial of service attacks.
10241
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010242 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10243 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10244 considered to be safe to retry.
10245
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010246 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10247 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10248 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10249 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10250 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010251
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010252 all-retryable-errors
10253 retry request for any error that are considered
10254 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10255 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10256 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10257
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010258 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10259 not cumulative.
10260
10261 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10262 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10263 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10264 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10265
10266 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10267 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10268 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10269 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10270 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10271 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10272 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10273 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10274 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10275 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10276 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10277 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10278
10279 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10280 should not use this directive.
10281
10282 The default is "conn-failure".
10283
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010284 Example:
10285 retry-on 503 504
10286
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010287 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10288
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010289server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010290 Declare a server in a backend
10291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10292 no | no | yes | yes
10293 Arguments :
10294 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010295 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010296 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010297
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010298 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10299 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10300 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10301 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010302 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10303 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010304 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010305 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10306 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010307 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10308 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10309 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10310 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10311 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10312 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10313 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010314 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010315 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10316 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10317 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10318 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10319 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10320 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010321 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10322 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010323 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10324 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010325
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010326 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010327 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10328 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10329 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10330 adding this value to the client's port.
10331
10332 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10333 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010334 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010335
10336 Examples :
10337 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10338 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010339 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010340 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10341 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10342 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010343
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010344 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10345 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10346 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10347 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10348 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10349
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010350 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10351 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010352
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010353server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010354 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010355 this backend.
10356 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10357 no | no | yes | yes
10358
10359 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10360 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10361 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10362 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10363 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010364
10365 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10366 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10367
10368 global
10369 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10370
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010371 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010372 load-server-state-from-file
10373
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010374 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010375 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010376
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010377server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10378 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10379 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10381 no | no | yes | yes
10382
10383 Arguments:
10384 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10385
10386 <num | range>
10387 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10388 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10389 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10390 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10391
10392 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10393
10394 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10395
10396 <params*>
10397 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10398 keyword.
10399
10400 Examples:
10401 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10402 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10403 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10404
10405 # or
10406 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10407
10408 # would be equivalent to:
10409 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10410 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10411 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10412
10413
10414
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010415source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010416source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010417source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010418 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10420 yes | no | yes | yes
10421 Arguments :
10422 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10423 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010424
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010425 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010426 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10427 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10428 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10429 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10430 supported prefixes are :
10431 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10432 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10433 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010434 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010435 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10436 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010437
10438 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10439 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010440 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10441 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10442 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010443
10444 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10445 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10446 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10447 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10448 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10449 <addr>.
10450
10451 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10452 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10453 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10454 port.
10455
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010456 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10457 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10458 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10459 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010460 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010461 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10462 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10463 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10464 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10465 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10466 HTTP header.
10467
10468 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10469 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010470 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010471 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10472 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10473 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10474 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10475 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10476 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10477 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10478
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010479 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10480 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10481 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10482 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10483 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10484 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10485
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010486 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10487 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10488 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10489 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10490
10491 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10492 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10493 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10494 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10495 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10496 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10497
10498 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10499 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10500 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10501 there are two methods :
10502
10503 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10504 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10505 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10506 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10507 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10508 of the client ranges may be used.
10509
10510 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10511 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10512 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10513 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10514 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10515 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10516 same session.
10517
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010518 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10519 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10520 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010521 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010522
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010523 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10524
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010525 Examples :
10526 backend private
10527 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10528 source 192.168.1.200
10529
10530 backend transparent_ssl1
10531 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10532 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10533
10534 backend transparent_ssl2
10535 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10536 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10537 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10538
10539 backend transparent_ssl3
10540 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10541 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10542 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10543
10544 backend transparent_smtp
10545 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10546 # with Tproxy version 4.
10547 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10548
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010549 backend transparent_http
10550 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10551 # proxy.
10552 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010554 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010555 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10556
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010557
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010558srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10559 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10560 the connection on the server side.
10561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10562 yes | no | yes | yes
10563 Arguments :
10564 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10565
10566 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10567 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010568 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10569 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010570
10571 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10572
10573
10574srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10575 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10576 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10577 server side.
10578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10579 yes | no | yes | yes
10580 Arguments :
10581 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10582 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10583 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10584 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10585
10586 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10587 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010588 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10589 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010590
10591 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10592
10593
10594srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10595 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10597 yes | no | yes | yes
10598 Arguments :
10599 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10600 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10601 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10602 document.
10603
10604 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10605 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010606 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10607 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010608
10609 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10610
10611
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010612stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10613 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010615 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010616
10617 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10618 matched.
10619
10620 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10621 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10622
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010623 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10624 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010625 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010626
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010627 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10628 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10629 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10630 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010631
10632 Example :
10633 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10634 backend stats_localhost
10635 stats enable
10636 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10637
10638 Example :
10639 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10640 backend stats_auth
10641 stats enable
10642 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10643 stats admin if TRUE
10644
10645 Example :
10646 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10647 userlist stats-auth
10648 group admin users admin
10649 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10650 group readonly users haproxy
10651 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10652
10653 backend stats_auth
10654 stats enable
10655 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10656 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10657 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10658 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10659
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010660 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10661 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10662 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010663
10664
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010665stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10666 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010668 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010669 Arguments :
10670 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10671
10672 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10673
10674 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10675 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10676 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10677 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10678 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10679 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10680
10681 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10682 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10683 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010684 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010685
10686 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10687 report using "stats scope".
10688
10689 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10690 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10691 unobvious parameters.
10692
10693 Example :
10694 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10695 backend public_www
10696 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10697 stats enable
10698 stats hide-version
10699 stats scope .
10700 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010701 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010702 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10703 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10704
10705 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10706 backend private_monitoring
10707 stats enable
10708 stats uri /admin?stats
10709 stats refresh 5s
10710
10711 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10712
10713
10714stats enable
10715 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010717 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010718 Arguments : none
10719
10720 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10721 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10722 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10723 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10724 - stats auth : no authentication
10725 - stats scope : no restriction
10726
10727 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10728 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10729 unobvious parameters.
10730
10731 Example :
10732 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10733 backend public_www
10734 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10735 stats enable
10736 stats hide-version
10737 stats scope .
10738 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010739 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010740 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10741 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10742
10743 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10744 backend private_monitoring
10745 stats enable
10746 stats uri /admin?stats
10747 stats refresh 5s
10748
10749 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10750
10751
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010752stats hide-version
10753 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010755 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010756 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010757
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010758 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10759 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10760 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10761 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10762 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10763 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010765 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10766 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10767 unobvious parameters.
10768
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010769 Example :
10770 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10771 backend public_www
10772 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010773 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010774 stats hide-version
10775 stats scope .
10776 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010777 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010778 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10779 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010780
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010781 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10782 backend private_monitoring
10783 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010784 stats uri /admin?stats
10785 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010786
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010787 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010788
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010789
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010790stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10791 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10792 Access control for statistics
10793
10794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10795 no | no | yes | yes
10796
10797 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10798 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10799 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10800 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10801 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10802 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10803
10804 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10805 instance.
10806
10807 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10808 about ACL usage.
10809
10810
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010811stats realm <realm>
10812 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010814 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010815 Arguments :
10816 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10817 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10818 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10819
10820 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10821 using a backslash ('\').
10822
10823 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10824 only related to authentication.
10825
10826 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10827 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10828 unobvious parameters.
10829
10830 Example :
10831 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10832 backend public_www
10833 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10834 stats enable
10835 stats hide-version
10836 stats scope .
10837 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010838 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010839 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10840 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10841
10842 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10843 backend private_monitoring
10844 stats enable
10845 stats uri /admin?stats
10846 stats refresh 5s
10847
10848 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10849
10850
10851stats refresh <delay>
10852 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010854 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010855 Arguments :
10856 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10857 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10858 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10859 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10860 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10861 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10862
10863 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10864 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10865 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010866 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010867
10868 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10869 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10870 unobvious parameters.
10871
10872 Example :
10873 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10874 backend public_www
10875 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10876 stats enable
10877 stats hide-version
10878 stats scope .
10879 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010880 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010881 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10882 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10883
10884 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10885 backend private_monitoring
10886 stats enable
10887 stats uri /admin?stats
10888 stats refresh 5s
10889
10890 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10891
10892
10893stats scope { <name> | "." }
10894 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010896 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010897 Arguments :
10898 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10899 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10900 section in which the statement appears.
10901
10902 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10903 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10904 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10905 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10906 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10907 exists.
10908
10909 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10910 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10911 unobvious parameters.
10912
10913 Example :
10914 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10915 backend public_www
10916 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10917 stats enable
10918 stats hide-version
10919 stats scope .
10920 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010921 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010922 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10923 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10924
10925 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10926 backend private_monitoring
10927 stats enable
10928 stats uri /admin?stats
10929 stats refresh 5s
10930
10931 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10932
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010933
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010934stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010935 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010937 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010938
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010939 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010940 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10941
10942 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10943 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10944
10945 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10946 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010947 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010948
10949 Example :
10950 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10951 backend private_monitoring
10952 stats enable
10953 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10954 stats uri /admin?stats
10955 stats refresh 5s
10956
10957 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10958 global section.
10959
10960
10961stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010962 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10964 yes | yes | yes | yes
10965 Arguments : none
10966
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010967 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010968 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10969 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10970 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10971 - IP (socket, server)
10972 - cookie (backend, server)
10973
10974 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10975 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010976 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010977
10978 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10979
10980
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010981stats show-modules
10982 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10984 yes | yes | yes | yes
10985 Arguments : none
10986
10987 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10988 values as a tooltip.
10989
10990 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10991 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10992 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10993
10994 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10995
10996
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010997stats show-node [ <name> ]
10998 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011000 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011001 Arguments:
11002 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11003 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11004
11005 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11006 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011007 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011008
11009 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11010 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11011 unobvious parameters.
11012
11013 Example:
11014 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11015 backend private_monitoring
11016 stats enable
11017 stats show-node Europe-1
11018 stats uri /admin?stats
11019 stats refresh 5s
11020
11021 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11022 section.
11023
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011024
11025stats uri <prefix>
11026 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011028 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011029 Arguments :
11030 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11031 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11032 query string.
11033
11034 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11035 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11036 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11037 possible to reach it in the application.
11038
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011039 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011040 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011041 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11042 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11043 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11044 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11045
11046 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11047 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11048 an address or a port to statistics only.
11049
11050 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11051 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11052 unobvious parameters.
11053
11054 Example :
11055 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11056 backend public_www
11057 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11058 stats enable
11059 stats hide-version
11060 stats scope .
11061 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011062 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011063 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11064 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11065
11066 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11067 backend private_monitoring
11068 stats enable
11069 stats uri /admin?stats
11070 stats refresh 5s
11071
11072 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11073
11074
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011075stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11076 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011078 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011079
11080 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011081 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011082 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011083 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011084 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11085
11086 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11087 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11088 the "stick-table" statement.
11089
11090 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11091 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11092 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11093 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11094 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11095
11096 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11097 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11098 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11099 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11100 transformation rules.
11101
11102 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11103 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11104 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11105 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11106 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11107 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11108 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11109
11110 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11111 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11112 ACL based conditions.
11113
11114 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11115 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11116 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11117 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11118
11119 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11120 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11121 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11122 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11123
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011124 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11125 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011126 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011127
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011128 Example :
11129 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11130 # last 30 minutes
11131 backend pop
11132 mode tcp
11133 balance roundrobin
11134 stick store-request src
11135 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11136 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11137 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11138
11139 backend smtp
11140 mode tcp
11141 balance roundrobin
11142 stick match src table pop
11143 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11144 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11145
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011146 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011147 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011148
11149
11150stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11151 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11153 no | no | yes | yes
11154
11155 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11156 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11157 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11158 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11159
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011160 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11161 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011162 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011163
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011164 Examples :
11165 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011166 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011167
11168 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11169 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11170 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11171
11172
11173 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11174 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11175 backend http
11176 mode http
11177 balance roundrobin
11178 stick on src table https
11179 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11180 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11181 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11182
11183 backend https
11184 mode tcp
11185 balance roundrobin
11186 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11187 stick on src
11188 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11189 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11190
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011191 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011192
11193
11194stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11195 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11197 no | no | yes | yes
11198
11199 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011200 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011201 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011202 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011203 server is selected.
11204
11205 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11206 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11207 the "stick-table" statement.
11208
11209 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11210 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11211 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11212 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11213 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11214 address.
11215
11216 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11217 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11218 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11219 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11220 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11221 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11222 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11223 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11224 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11225 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11226
11227 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11228 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11229 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11230 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11231 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11232 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11233 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11234
11235 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11236 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11237 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11238 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11239
11240 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11241 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11242 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11243 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11244 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11245 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011246 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11247 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11248 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11249 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11250 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11251 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011252
11253 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11254 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11255 the request.
11256
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011257 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11258 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011259 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011260
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011261 Example :
11262 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11263 # last 30 minutes
11264 backend pop
11265 mode tcp
11266 balance roundrobin
11267 stick store-request src
11268 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11269 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11270 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11271
11272 backend smtp
11273 mode tcp
11274 balance roundrobin
11275 stick match src table pop
11276 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11277 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11278
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011279 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011280 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011281
11282
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011283stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011284 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011285 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011286 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011288 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011289
11290 Arguments :
11291 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11292 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11293 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11294 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11295
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011296 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11297 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11298 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11299 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11300
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011301 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11302 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11303 instance.
11304
11305 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11306 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11307 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11308 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11309 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11310 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011311 to 32 characters.
11312
11313 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11314 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11315 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011316 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011317 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11318 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011319
11320 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011321 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11322 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011323 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11324 increase.
11325
11326 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011327 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11328 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11329 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011330
11331 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011332 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011333 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11334 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011335 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011336 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11337 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11338 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11339 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11340 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11341 parameter (see below).
11342
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011343 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11344 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11345 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11346 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11347 soft restart.
11348
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011349 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11350 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011351
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011352 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011353 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11354 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011355 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11356 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011357 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011358 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011359 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11360 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011361 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11362 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011363
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011364 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11365 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11366 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11367 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11368 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11369 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11370 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11371 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11372 token.
11373
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011374 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11375 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11376 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11377 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011378 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11379 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11380 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11381 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11382 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11383 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11384 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11385 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11386 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11387 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11388 types and their arguments.
11389
11390 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11391 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11392 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11393 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11394
11395 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11396 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11397 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011398 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011399
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011400 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11401 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11402 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011403 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011404 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011405 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011406
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011407 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11408 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11409 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11410 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11411
11412 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11413 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11414 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11415 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11416 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11417 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11418
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011419 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11420 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11421 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11422 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11423
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011424 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11425 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11426 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11427 they were received.
11428
11429 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11430 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11431 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11432 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11433 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11434
11435 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11436 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11437 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11438 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11439 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11440
11441 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11442 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11443 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11444
11445 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11446 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11447 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11448 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11449 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11450
11451 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11452 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11453 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11454 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11455 the client side.
11456
11457 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11458 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11459 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11460 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11461 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11462 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11463 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11464
11465 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11466 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11467 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11468 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11469 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11470 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011471 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011472
11473 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11474 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11475 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11476 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11477 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11478 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11479
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011480 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11481 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11482 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11483 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11484 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11485
11486 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11487 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11488 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11489 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11490 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11491 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11492
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011493 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011494 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011495 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11496 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11497
11498 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11499 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11500 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11501 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11502 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11503 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11504 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11505 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11506 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11507 recommended for better fairness.
11508
11509 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011510 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011511 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11512 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11513
11514 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11515 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11516 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11517 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11518 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11519 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11520 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11521 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11522 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11523 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011524
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011525 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11526 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011527 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11528 reference it.
11529
11530 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11531 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011532 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11533 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11534 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011535
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011536 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11537 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11538 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11539 something that can be ignored.
11540
11541 Example:
11542 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11543 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11544 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11545 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11546
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011547 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011548 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011549
11550
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011551stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011552 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11554 no | no | yes | yes
11555
11556 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011557 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011558 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011559 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011560 server is selected.
11561
11562 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11563 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11564 the "stick-table" statement.
11565
11566 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11567 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11568 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11569 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11570
11571 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11572 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11573 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11574 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11575 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11576 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011577 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011578 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11579 rules.
11580
11581 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11582 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11583 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11584 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11585 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11586 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11587 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11588
11589 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11590 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11591 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11592 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11593
11594 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11595 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11596 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11597 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11598 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11599 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011600 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11601 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11602 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11603 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11604 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11605 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11606 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11607 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11608 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011609
11610 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11611
11612 Example :
11613 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11614 backend https
11615 mode tcp
11616 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011617 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011618 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011619
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011620 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11621 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011622
11623 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11624 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11625 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11626
11627 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11628 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011629
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011630 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11631 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11632 # at offset 44.
11633
11634 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011635 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011636
11637 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011638 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011639
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011640 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11641 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11642
11643 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11644 extraction.
11645
11646
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011647tcp-check comment <string>
11648 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11649 it fails.
11650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11651 yes | no | yes | yes
11652
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011653 Arguments :
11654 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11655 rule fails.
11656
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011657 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11658 user-friendly error reporting.
11659
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011660 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11661 "tcp-check expect".
11662
11663
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011664tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11665 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011666 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011667 Opens a new connection
11668 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011669 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011670
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011671 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011672 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11673
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011674 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011675 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011676
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011677 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011678 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11679 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011680 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011681
11682 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011683
11684 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11685
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011686 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11687
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011688 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11689
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011690 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11691
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011692 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11693 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11694 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11695 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11696
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011697 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11698 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11699 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11700 haproxy -vv.
11701
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011702 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011703
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011704 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11705 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11706 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11707
11708 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11709 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11710 of the sequence.
11711
11712 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11713 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11714 do.
11715
11716 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11717 unset-var or comment rules.
11718
11719 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011720 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11721 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11722 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11723 option tcp-check
11724 tcp-check connect
11725 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11726 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11727 tcp-check send \r\n
11728 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11729 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11730 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11731 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11732 tcp-check send \r\n
11733 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11734 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11735
11736 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11737 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011738 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011739 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11740 tcp-check connect port 143
11741 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11742 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11743
11744 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11745
11746
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011747tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011748 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011749 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011750 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011751 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011752 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011753 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011754
11755 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011756 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11757
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011758 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11759 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11760 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11761 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11762 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11763 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11764 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11765 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11766 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11767 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11768
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011769 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011770 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11771 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011772 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11773 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11774 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11775
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011776 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11777 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11778 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011779 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11780 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011781 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11782 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011783 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11784 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011785 By default "L7OK" is used.
11786
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011787 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11788 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011789 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11790 supported :
11791 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11792 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011793 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11794 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11795 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11796 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11797 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011798
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011799 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011800 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011801 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11802 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11803 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11804 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011805 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11806
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011807 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11808 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11809 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11810 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11811
11812 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11813 informational message reported in logs if an error
11814 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11815 log-format string.
11816
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011817 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11818 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11819 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11820 followed by some converters.
11821
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011822 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11823 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11824 with the usual backslash ('\').
11825 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011826 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011827 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11828 used upper or lower case.
11829
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011830 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11831
11832 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11833 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11834 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11835 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11836 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11837 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11838 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11839 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11840
11841 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11842 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11843 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11844 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11845 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11846 expression.
11847
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011848 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11849 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11850 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11851 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11852 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11853 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11854
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011855 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11856 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11857 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11858 this exact hexadecimal string.
11859 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11860
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011861 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11862 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11863 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11864 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11865 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11866 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11867 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11868 size.
11869
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011870 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11871 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11872 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11873 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11874 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11875 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11876 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11877 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11878 in a binary string before matching the response's
11879 buffer.
11880
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011881 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011882 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011883 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11884 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11885 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11886 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11887 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11888 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11889 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11890 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11891 the null character.
11892
11893 Examples :
11894 # perform a POP check
11895 option tcp-check
11896 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11897
11898 # perform an IMAP check
11899 option tcp-check
11900 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11901
11902 # look for the redis master server
11903 option tcp-check
11904 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011905 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011906 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11907 tcp-check expect string role:master
11908 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11909 tcp-check expect string +OK
11910
11911
11912 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011913 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011914
11915
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011916tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11917tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11918 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11919 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011920 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011921 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011922
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011923 Arguments :
11924 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11925
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011926 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11927 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011928
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011929 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11930 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011931
11932 Examples :
11933 # look for the redis master server
11934 option tcp-check
11935 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11936 tcp-check expect string role:master
11937
11938 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011939 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011940
11941
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011942tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11943tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11944 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11945 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011946 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011947 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011948
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011949 Arguments :
11950 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011951
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011952 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11953 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011954
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011955 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11956 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11957 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011958
11959 Examples :
11960 # redis check in binary
11961 option tcp-check
11962 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11963 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11964
11965
11966 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011967 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011968
11969
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011970tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011971 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011972 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011973 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011974
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011975 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011976 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11977 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11978 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11979 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11980 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11981 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11982 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11983 and '-'.
11984
11985 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11986
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011987 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011988 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11989
11990
11991tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011992 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011994 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011995
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011996 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011997 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11998 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11999 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12000 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12001 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12002 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12003 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12004 and '-'.
12005
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012006 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012007 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12008
12009
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012010tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12011 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12013 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012014 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012015 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12016 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012018 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012019
12020 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12021 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012022 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12023 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12024 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12025 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12026 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12027 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012028
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012029 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12030 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12031 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12032 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012033
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012034 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012035 - accept :
12036 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12037 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12038 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012040 - reject :
12041 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12042 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12043 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12044 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12045 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12046 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12047 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12048 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12049 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12050 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12051 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012052 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012053
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012054 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12055 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12056 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12057 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12058 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12059 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12060 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12061 hosts.
12062
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012063 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12064 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12065 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12066 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12067 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12068 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12069 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12070 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12071
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012072 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12073 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12074 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12075 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12076 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12077 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12078 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12079 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12080 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012081 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12082 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012083
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012084 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012085 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012086 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12087 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12088 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012089 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012090 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012091 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12092 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12093 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12094 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12095 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12096 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12097 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012098
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012099 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012100 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012101 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012102 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012103 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12104 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12105 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012106
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012107 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12108 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12109 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12110 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012112 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12113 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12114 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12115 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12116 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012117 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12118 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12119 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12120 layer7 information is extracted.
12121
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012122 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12123 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12124 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12125 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12126 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012127
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012128 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12129 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12130 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12131 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12132
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012133 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12134 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12135 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12136 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12137
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012138 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12139 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12140 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12141 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12142 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012143
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012144 - set-src <expr> :
12145 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12146 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12147 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012148 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012149
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012150 Arguments:
12151 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12152 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012153
12154 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012155 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12156
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012157 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12158 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012159
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012160 - set-src-port <expr> :
12161 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12162 expression.
12163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012164 Arguments:
12165 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12166 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012167
12168 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012169 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12170
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012171 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12172 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12173 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012174
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012175 - set-dst <expr> :
12176 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12177 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12178 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12179 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12180 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12181
12182 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12183 followed by some converters.
12184
12185 Example:
12186
12187 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12188 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12189
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012190 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12191 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12192
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012193 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12194 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12195 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12196 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12197
12198
12199 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12200 followed by some converters.
12201
12202 Example:
12203
12204 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12205
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012206 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12207 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12208 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12209
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012210 - "silent-drop" :
12211 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012212 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012213 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12214 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12215 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12216 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12217 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012218 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12219 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012220 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12221 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012222 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012223 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12224 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12225 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12226 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12227
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012228 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12229 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12230 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012231
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012232 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12233 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12234 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012236 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012237 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012238 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012239
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012240 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12241 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12242 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012244 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012245 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12246 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012247
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012248 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12249
12250 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12251
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012252 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12253
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012254 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012255
12256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012257tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12258 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012260 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012261 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012262 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12263 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012265 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012266
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012267 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012268 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12269 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012270 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12271 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012273 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12274 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12275 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12276 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012277 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012278 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012279 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12280 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12281 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12282 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012283 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012284 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012285
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012286 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12287 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12288 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12289 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012290
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012291 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012292 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012293 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012294 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12295 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012296 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012297 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012298 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012299 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012300 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012301 - set-dst <expr>
12302 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012303 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012304 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012305 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012306 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012307 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012308 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012309
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012310 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12311 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012312 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12313 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012314
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012315 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12316 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12317 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12318 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12319 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12320 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012322 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012323 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12324 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012325
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012326 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12327 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12328 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12329 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12330 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12331 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12332
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012333 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012334 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12335 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12336 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12337 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12338 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12339 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12340 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12341 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12342 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12343 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012344
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012345 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012346 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12347 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12348 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012349
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012350 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12351 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12352
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012353 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012354 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12355 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012356
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012357 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12358 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012359 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012360 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12361 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012362 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012363 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012364 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012365 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12366 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012367 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012368 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12369 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012370
12371 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12372 followed by some converters.
12373
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012374 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012375 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12376 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12377 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12378 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12379 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12380 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012381 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012382 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12383 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12384
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012385 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12386
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012387 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12388 <var-name>.
12389
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012390 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12391 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12392 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12393 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12394 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12395
12396 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12397 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12398 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12399 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12400 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12401 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12402 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12403 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12404 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12405 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12406 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12407
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012408 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12409 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12410 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12411 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12412 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12413
12414 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12415
12416 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12417
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012418 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12419 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12420 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12421 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12422 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12423 evaluated.
12424
12425 Example:
12426 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12427
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012428 Example:
12429
12430 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012431 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012432
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012433 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012434 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012435 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012436 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12437 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012438 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012439 tcp-request content reject
12440
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012441 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12442 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12443 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12444 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12445 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12446 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12447 ...
12448 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12449
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012450 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012451 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12452 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012453 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012454 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012455
12456 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12457 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012458 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012459 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012460 tcp-request content reject
12461
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012462 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012463 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012464 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012465 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012466 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12467 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012468
12469 Example:
12470 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12471 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012472 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012473
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012474 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012475 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012476
12477 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012478 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012479 # protecting all our sites
12480 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012481 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12482 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012483 ...
12484 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12485
12486 backend http_dynamic
12487 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012488 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012489 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012490 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012491 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012492 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012493 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012495 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012496
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012497 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12498 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012499
12500
12501tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12502 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012504 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012505 Arguments :
12506 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12507 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12508 as explained at the top of this document.
12509
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012510 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012511 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12512 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12513 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12514 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12515
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012516 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12517 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12518 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12519 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12520
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012521 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012522 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012523 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012524 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012525 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012526 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12527 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12528 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012529
12530 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12531 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12532 it pass through unaffected.
12533
12534 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12535 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12536 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012537 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012538 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12539 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012540 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12541 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12542 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012543
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012544 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012545 "timeout client".
12546
12547
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012548tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12549 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12551 no | no | yes | yes
12552 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012553 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12554 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012555
12556 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12557
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012558 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012559 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12560 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012561 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12562 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012563
12564 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12565
12566 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12567 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12568 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12569 inserted.
12570
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012571 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012572 - accept :
12573 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12574 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12575 the rules evaluation.
12576
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012577 - close :
12578 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12579 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12580 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12581 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12582 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12583 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012584 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012585 protocols.
12586
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012587 - reject :
12588 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12589 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012590 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012591
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012592 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012593 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012594
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012595 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12596 Unsets a variable.
12597
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012598 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12599 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12600 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12601 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12602
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012603 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12604 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12605 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12606 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12607
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012608 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12609 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12610 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12611 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12612 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012613
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012614 - "silent-drop" :
12615 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012616 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012617 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12618 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12619 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12620 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12621 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012622 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12623 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012624 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12625 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012626 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012627 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12628 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12629 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12630 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12631
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012632 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12633 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12634
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012635 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12636 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12637 for changing the default action to a reject.
12638
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012639 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12640 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12641 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12642 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012643 period.
12644
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012645 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12646 declared inline.
12647
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012648 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12649 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012650 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012651 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12652 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012653 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012654 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012655 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012656 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12657 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012658 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012659 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12660 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012661
12662 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12663 followed by some converters.
12664
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012665 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12666 <var-name>.
12667
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012668 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12669 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12670 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12671 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12672 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12673
12674 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12675
12676 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12677
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012678 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12679
12680 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12681
12682
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012683tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12684 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12686 no | yes | yes | no
12687 Arguments :
12688 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12689 below.
12690
12691 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12692
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012693 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012694 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12695 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12696 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12697 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12698 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12699 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12700 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012701 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012702 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12703 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12704 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12705 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12706 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12707 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12708 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12709 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12710 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12711 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12712 instead.
12713
12714 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12715 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12716 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12717 rules which may be inserted.
12718
12719 Several types of actions are supported :
12720 - accept : the request is accepted
12721 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12722 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12723 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012724 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012725 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012726 - set-dst <expr>
12727 - set-dst-port <expr>
12728 - set-src <expr>
12729 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012730 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012731 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012732 - silent-drop
12733
12734 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12735 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12736 sections for a complete description.
12737
12738 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12739 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12740 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12741
12742 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12743 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12744 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12745 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12746 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12747
12748 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12749 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12750
12751 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12752 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12753 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12754
12755 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12756 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12757 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12758
12759 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12760 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12761 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12762
12763 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12764 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12765 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12766
12767 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12768
12769 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12770
12771
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012772tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12773 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12775 no | no | yes | yes
12776 Arguments :
12777 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12778 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12779 as explained at the top of this document.
12780
12781 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12782
12783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012784timeout check <timeout>
12785 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12786 established.
12787
12788 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12789 yes | no | yes | yes
12790 Arguments:
12791 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12792 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12793 as explained at the top of this document.
12794
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012795 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012796 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012797 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012798 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012799 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12800 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12801 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012802
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012803 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012804 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12805
12806 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12807 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012808 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012809
12810 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12811 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12812 forget about it.
12813
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012814 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12815 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012816
12817
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012818timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012819 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12821 yes | yes | yes | no
12822 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012823 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012824 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12825 as explained at the top of this document.
12826
12827 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12828 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12829 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012830 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12831 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12832 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12833 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012834 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12835 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12836 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012837 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012838 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012839 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12840 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012841 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12842 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012843
12844 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12845 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12846 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12847 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012848 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012849 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12850
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012851 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012852
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012853
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012854timeout client-fin <timeout>
12855 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12857 yes | yes | yes | no
12858 Arguments :
12859 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12860 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12861 as explained at the top of this document.
12862
12863 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12864 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12865 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12866 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12867 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12868 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12869 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012870 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12871 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12872 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012873
12874 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12875 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12876 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12877
12878 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12879
12880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012881timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012882 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12884 yes | no | yes | yes
12885 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012886 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012887 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12888 as explained at the top of this document.
12889
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012890 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012891 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012892 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012893 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012894 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12895 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012896
12897 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12898 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12899 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12900 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012901 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012902 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12903
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012904 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012905
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012906
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012907timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12908 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12910 yes | yes | yes | yes
12911 Arguments :
12912 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12913 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12914 as explained at the top of this document.
12915
12916 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12917 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12918 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12919 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12920 once the request has started to present itself.
12921
12922 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12923 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12924 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12925 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12926 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12927
12928 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12929 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12930 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12931 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12932
12933 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12934 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012935 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012936 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12937 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012938 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012939
12940 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12941 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12942 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12943 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12944
12945 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12946
12947
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012948timeout http-request <timeout>
12949 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012951 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012952 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012953 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012954 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12955 as explained at the top of this document.
12956
12957 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12958 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12959 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12960 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12961 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12962 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12963 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012964 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12965 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12966 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12967 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012968 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012969 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12970 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012971
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012972 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12973 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12974 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12975 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12976 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012977 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012978
12979 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12980 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012981 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012982 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12983 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12984
12985 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012986 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12987 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12988 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012989
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012990 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012991 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012992
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012993
12994timeout queue <timeout>
12995 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12997 yes | no | yes | yes
12998 Arguments :
12999 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13000 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13001 as explained at the top of this document.
13002
13003 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13004 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13005 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13006 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13007 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13008
13009 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13010 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13011 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13012 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13013
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013014 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013015
13016
13017timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013018 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13020 yes | no | yes | yes
13021 Arguments :
13022 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13023 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13024 as explained at the top of this document.
13025
13026 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13027 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13028 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13029 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13030 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13031 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13032 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13033
13034 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13035 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13036 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13037 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13038 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013039 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013040 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013041 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13042 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013043 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13044 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013045
13046 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13047 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13048 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13049 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013050 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013051 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13052
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013053 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013054
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013055
13056timeout server-fin <timeout>
13057 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13059 yes | no | yes | yes
13060 Arguments :
13061 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13062 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13063 as explained at the top of this document.
13064
13065 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13066 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13067 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13068 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13069 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13070 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13071 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13072 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13073 situations, it should not be needed.
13074
13075 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13076 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13077 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13078
13079 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13080
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013081
13082timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013083 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13085 yes | yes | yes | yes
13086 Arguments :
13087 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13088 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13089 as explained at the top of this document.
13090
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013091 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13092 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13093 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013094
13095 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13096 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13097 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13098 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013099 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013100
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013101 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013102
13103
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013104timeout tunnel <timeout>
13105 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13107 yes | no | yes | yes
13108 Arguments :
13109 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13110 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13111 as explained at the top of this document.
13112
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013113 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013114 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13115 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13116 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013117 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13118 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013119 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13120 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13121 specified.
13122
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013123 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13124 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13125 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13126 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13127 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13128 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13129 state.
13130
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013131 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13132 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13133 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13134 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013135 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013136
13137 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13138 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13139 forget about it.
13140
13141 Example :
13142 defaults http
13143 option http-server-close
13144 timeout connect 5s
13145 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013146 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013147 timeout server 30s
13148 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13149
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013150 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013151
13152
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013153transparent (deprecated)
13154 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013156 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013157 Arguments : none
13158
13159 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13160 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13161 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13162 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13163 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13164 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13165 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13166 appropriate server.
13167
13168 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13169
13170 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13171 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13172
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013173 See also: "option transparent"
13174
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013175unique-id-format <string>
13176 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13178 yes | yes | yes | no
13179 Arguments :
13180 <string> is a log-format string.
13181
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013182 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13183 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13184 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13185 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013186
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013187 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013188 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013189 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13190 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13191 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13192 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13193 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13194 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013195
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013196 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13197 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013198
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013199 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013200
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013201 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013202
13203 will generate:
13204
13205 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13206
13207 See also: "unique-id-header"
13208
13209unique-id-header <name>
13210 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13212 yes | yes | yes | no
13213 Arguments :
13214 <name> is the name of the header.
13215
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013216 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13217 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013218
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013219 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013220
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013221 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013222 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13223
13224 will generate:
13225
13226 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13227
13228 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013229
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013230use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013231 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13233 no | yes | yes | no
13234 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013235 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13236 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013237
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013238 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13239 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013240
13241 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13242 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13243 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013244 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013245 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013246 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13247 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013248
13249 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13250 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13251 assign the backend.
13252
13253 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13254 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13255 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13256 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13257 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13258 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13259
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013260 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013261 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013262 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13263 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13264 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13265
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013266 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13267 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13268 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13269 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13270 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13271 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13272 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13273 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13274 cannot be forced from the request.
13275
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013276 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013277 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13278 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13279
13280 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13281 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013282
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013283use-fcgi-app <name>
13284 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13286 no | no | yes | yes
13287 Arguments :
13288 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13289
13290 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013291
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013292use-server <server> if <condition>
13293use-server <server> unless <condition>
13294 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13296 no | no | yes | yes
13297 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013298 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13299 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013300
13301 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13302
13303 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13304 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13305 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13306
13307 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13308 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13309 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13310 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13311 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13312 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13313 matches will assign the server.
13314
13315 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13316 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13317 with the next rules until one matches.
13318
13319 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13320 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13321 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13322 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13323
13324 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13325 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13326 stripped.
13327
13328 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13329 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013330 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013331 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013332 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013333
13334 Example :
13335 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013336 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013337 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013338 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013339 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013340 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013341 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013342 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13343 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13344
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013345 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13346 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13347 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13348 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013349 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013350 and we fall back to load balancing.
13351
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013352 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013353
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133555. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013356--------------------------
13357
13358The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13359depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13360settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13361written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13362described in this section.
13363
13364
133655.1. Bind options
13366-----------------
13367
13368The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13369as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13370no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13371parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13372while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13373provided immediately after the setting name.
13374
13375The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13376
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013377accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13378 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13379 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13380 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13381 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13382 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13383 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13384 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13385 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13386 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013387 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13388 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13389 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013391accept-proxy
13392 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013393 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13394 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013395 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13396 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13397 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13398 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013399 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013400 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13401 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013402 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13403 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013404
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013405allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013406 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013407 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013408 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013409 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13410 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013411
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013412alpn <protocols>
13413 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13414 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13415 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013416 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013417 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013418 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13419 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13420 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13421 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13422 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13423 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13424 preference, like below :
13425
13426 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013427
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013428backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013429 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013430 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13431
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013432curves <curves>
13433 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13434 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13435 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13436 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13437 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13438 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13439
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013440ecdhe <named curve>
13441 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013442 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13443 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013444
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013445ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13447 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13448 client's certificate.
13449
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013450ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13452 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13453 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13454 error is ignored.
13455
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013456ca-sign-file <cafile>
13457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13458 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13459 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13460 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13461 'generate-certificates' for details.
13462
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013463ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13465 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13466 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13467 'generate-certificates' for details.
13468
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013469ca-verify-file <cafile>
13470 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13471 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13472 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13473 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13474 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13475
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013476ciphers <ciphers>
13477 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13478 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013479 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013480 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013481 information and recommendations see e.g.
13482 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13483 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13484 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13485
13486ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13487 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13488 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13489 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13490 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013491 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13492 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013493
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013494crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013495 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13496 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013497 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13498 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013499
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013500crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013501 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13502 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13503 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13504 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13505 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013506 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13507 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013508
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013509 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13510 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13511
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013512 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13513 are loaded.
13514
13515 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013516 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13517 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13518 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13519 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13520 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13521 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13522 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013523 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013524
13525 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13526 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13527 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13528 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013529 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13530 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013531
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013532 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013533
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013534 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013535 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013536 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13537 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013538 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13539 clients).
13540
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013541 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013542 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13543 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13544 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13545 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13546 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13547 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13548 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13549 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13550 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13551 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13552 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13553 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13554
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013555 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013556 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13557 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13558 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13559 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13560
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013561 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13562 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13563 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13564 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013565
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013566 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13567 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13568 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013569
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013570crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013572 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013573 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013574 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013575
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013576crt-list <file>
13577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013578 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13579 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013580
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013581 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13582
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013583 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13584 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13585 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13586 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13587 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013588
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013589 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013590 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13591 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13592 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13593 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13594 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013595 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13596 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13597 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013598
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013599 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13600 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13601 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013602
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013603 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13604
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013605 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013606 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013607 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13608 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13609 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13610 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13611 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13612 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013613
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013614 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013615 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013616 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013617 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013618 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013619 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013620
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013621defer-accept
13622 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13623 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13624 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013625 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013626 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13627 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13628 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13629 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13630 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13631 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13632 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13633
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013634expose-fd listeners
13635 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13636 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013637 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13638 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013639 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013640
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013641force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013642 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013643 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013644 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013645 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013646
13647force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013648 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013649 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013650 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013651
13652force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013653 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013654 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013655 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013656
13657force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013658 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013659 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013660 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013661
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013662force-tlsv13
13663 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13664 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013665 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013666
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013667generate-certificates
13668 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13669 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13670 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13671 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13672 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13673 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13674 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13675 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13676 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13677 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13678 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13679
13680 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13681 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013682 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013683 certificate is used many times.
13684
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013685gid <gid>
13686 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13687 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13688 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13689 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13690 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13691
13692group <group>
13693 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13694 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13695 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13696 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13697 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13698
13699id <id>
13700 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13701 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13702 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13703 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13704
13705interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013706 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13707 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13708 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13709 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13710 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13711 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013712 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13713 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13714 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13715 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13716 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13717 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013718
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013719level <level>
13720 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13721 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13722 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013723 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013724 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13725 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13726 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013727 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013728 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013729 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013730 all counters).
13731
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013732severity-output <format>
13733 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13734 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13735 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13736 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13737 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13738 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13739 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13740 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13741 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13742 rfc5424 convention.
13743
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013744maxconn <maxconn>
13745 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13746 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13747 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13748 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13749 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13750 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13751 eat all memory.
13752
13753mode <mode>
13754 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13755 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13756 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13757 UNIX sockets.
13758
13759mss <maxseg>
13760 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13761 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13762 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13763 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13764 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13765 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13766 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13767 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13768 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13769 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13770 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13771
13772name <name>
13773 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13774 page.
13775
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013776namespace <name>
13777 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13778 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13779 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13780 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13781
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013782nice <nice>
13783 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13784 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13785 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13786 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13787 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13788 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13789 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13790 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13791 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13792 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13793 one for an RDP socket.
13794
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013795no-ca-names
13796 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13797 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013798 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013799
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013800no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013802 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013803 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013804 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013805 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13806 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013807
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013808no-tls-tickets
13809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13810 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13811 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013812 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13813 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013814 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13815 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13816 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013817
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013818no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013820 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013821 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013822 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013823 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13824 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013825
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013826no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013828 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013829 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013830 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013831 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13832 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013833
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013834no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013836 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013837 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013838 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013839 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13840 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013841
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013842no-tlsv13
13843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13844 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13845 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13846 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013847 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13848 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013849
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013850npn <protocols>
13851 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13852 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13853 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013854 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013855 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013856 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13857 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13858 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13859 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13860 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013861
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013862prefer-client-ciphers
13863 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13864 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13865 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013866 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13867 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13868 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013869
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013870process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013871 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013872 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013873 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013874 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13875 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13876 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13877 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013878 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013879 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13880 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13881 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13882 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13883 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013884
13885 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13886
13887 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13888 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13889 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13890 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13891 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13892 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13893 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13894 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013895
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013896proto <name>
13897 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13898 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13899 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013900 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13901 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13902
13903 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13904 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13905 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13906 also reported (flag=HTX).
13907
13908 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13909 a bind line :
13910
13911 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13912 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13913 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13914
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013915 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013916 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013917 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013918 h2" on the bind line.
13919
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013920ssl
13921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013922 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013923 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13924 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013925 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13926 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013927
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013928ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13929 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013930 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13931 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13932 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013933 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13934
13935ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013936 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13937 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13938 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13939 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013940
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013941strict-sni
13942 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13943 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13944 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13945 See the "crt" option for more information.
13946
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013947tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013948 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013949 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013950 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013951 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013952 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13953 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13954 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13955 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13956 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13957 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13958 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13959
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013960tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013961 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013962 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13963 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13964 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13965 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13966 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13967 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13968 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013969 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13970 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13971 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013972
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013973tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13974 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013975 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13976 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13977 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13978 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13979 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13980 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13981 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13982 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13983 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13984 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013985 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13986 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13987
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013988transparent
13989 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13990 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13991 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13992 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13993 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13994 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13995 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13996 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13997 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13998 so check for support with your vendor.
13999
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014000v4v6
14001 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14002 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14003 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14004 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014005 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014006
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014007v6only
14008 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14009 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14010 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014011 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14012 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014013
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014014uid <uid>
14015 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14016 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14017 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14018 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14019 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14020
14021user <user>
14022 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14023 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14024 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14025 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14026 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14027
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014028verify [none|optional|required]
14029 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14030 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14031 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14032 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14033 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014034 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14035 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14036 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14037 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014038
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140395.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014040------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014042The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14043which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14044arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14045settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14046after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14047Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14048address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014050 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014051 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014052
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014053Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14054keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014056The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014057
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014058addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014059 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014060 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14061 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14062 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14063 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14064 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014065
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014066agent-check
14067 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014068 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014069 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14070 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14071 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014072
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014073 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014074 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014075 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014076 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14077 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014078
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014079 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14080 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14081 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14082 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14083 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014084
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014085 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014086 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014087
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014088 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14089 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14090 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014091
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014092 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14093 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14094 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014095
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014096 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014097 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14098 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14099 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14100 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014101 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014102 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014103
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014104 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14105 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014106
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014107 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14108 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14109 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14110 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14111 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14112 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14113 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14114 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14115 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014116
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014117 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14118 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014119 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14120 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14121 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014122 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014123
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014124 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014125 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014126
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014127agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014128 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014129 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14130 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14131 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14132 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14133
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014134agent-inter <delay>
14135 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14136 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14137
14138 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14139 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14140 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14141 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14142 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14143 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14144 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14145 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14146 of backends use the same servers.
14147
14148 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14149
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014150agent-addr <addr>
14151 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14152
14153 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014154 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014155 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14156 hostname, it will be resolved.
14157
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014158agent-port <port>
14159 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14160
14161 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14162
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014163allow-0rtt
14164 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014165 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14166 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014167
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014168alpn <protocols>
14169 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14170 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14171 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014172 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014173 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14174 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14175 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14176 now obsolete NPN extension.
14177 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14178 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14179
14180 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14181
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014182 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014184backup
14185 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14186 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14187 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14188 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014189 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14190 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014191
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014192ca-file <cafile>
14193 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14194 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14195 server's certificate.
14196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014197check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014198 This option enables health checks on a server:
14199 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14200 considered available.
14201 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14202 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14203 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14204 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14205 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14206 set.
14207 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14208 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14209 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14210 exchanges succeed.
14211
14212 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14213 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14214 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14215 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14216 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014217 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014218 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14219
14220 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14221 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14222
14223 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14224 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14225
14226 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14227 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14228 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14229 available.
14230
14231 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14232 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14233 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14234
14235 Example:
14236 # simple tcp check
14237 backend foo
14238 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14239 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14240 backend foo
14241 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14242 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14243 backend foo
14244 option tcp-check
14245 tcp-check connect
14246 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014247
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014248check-send-proxy
14249 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14250 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14251 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14252 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14253 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14254 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14255 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14256
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014257check-alpn <protocols>
14258 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14259 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14260 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14261
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014262check-proto <name>
14263 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14264 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14265 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014266 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14267 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14268
14269 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14270 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14271 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14272 also reported (flag=HTX).
14273
14274 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14275 directive on a server line:
14276
14277 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14278 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14279 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14280 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14281
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014282 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014283 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14284 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14285
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014286check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014287 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014288 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14289 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014290
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014291check-ssl
14292 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14293 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14294 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14295 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014296 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014297 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14298 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014299 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014300 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14301 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014302
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014303check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014304 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014305 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14306 for normal traffic.
14307
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014308ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14310 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14311 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014312 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14313 information and recommendations see e.g.
14314 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14315 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14316 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014317
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014318ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14320 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14321 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14322 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014323 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14324 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14325 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014327cookie <value>
14328 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14329 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14330 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14331 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14332 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14333 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14334 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14335
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014336crl-file <crlfile>
14337 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14338 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14339 to verify server's certificate.
14340
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014341crt <cert>
14342 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14343 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14344 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14345 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14346 certificate request.
14347
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014348 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14349 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14350 option is set accordingly).
14351
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014352disabled
14353 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14354 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14355 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14356 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14357 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014358 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014359
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014360enabled
14361 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14362 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14363 default value.
14364 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14365 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014367error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014368 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14369 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14370 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014372 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014374fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014375 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14376 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14377 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14378
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014379force-sslv3
14380 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14381 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014382 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014383 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014384
14385force-tlsv10
14386 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014387 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014388 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014389
14390force-tlsv11
14391 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014392 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014393 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014394
14395force-tlsv12
14396 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014397 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014398 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014399
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014400force-tlsv13
14401 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14402 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014403 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014405id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014406 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14407 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14408 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014409
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014410init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14411 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14412 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014413 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014414 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14415 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14416 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14417 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14418 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14419 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14420 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14421 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14422 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014423 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014424 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14425 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14426 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14427 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14428 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14429 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014430 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014431
14432 Example:
14433 defaults
14434 # never fail on address resolution
14435 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014437inter <delay>
14438fastinter <delay>
14439downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014440 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14441 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14442 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14443 between checks depending on the server state :
14444
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014445 Server state | Interval used
14446 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14447 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14448 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14449 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14450 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14451 or yet unchecked. |
14452 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14453 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14454 | "inter" otherwise.
14455 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014457 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14458 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14459 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14460 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014461 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14462 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14463 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14464 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14465 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014466
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014467log-proto <logproto>
14468 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14469 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14470 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14471 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014473maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014474 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14475 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014476 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14477 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014478 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14479 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14480 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14481 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14482
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014483 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14484 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14485 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14486 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14487 than 50 concurrent requests.
14488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014489maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014490 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14491 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14492 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14493 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014494 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14495 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14496 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14497 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14498 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14499 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14500 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014501
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014502max-reuse <count>
14503 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14504 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14505 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14506 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14507 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14508 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14509 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14510 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014512minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014513 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14514 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14515 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14516 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14517 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14518 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014519 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014520 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014521
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014522namespace <name>
14523 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14524 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14525 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14526 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14527
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014528no-agent-check
14529 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14530 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14531 default value.
14532 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14533 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14534
14535no-backup
14536 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14537 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14538 default value.
14539 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14540 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14541
14542no-check
14543 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14544 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14545 default value.
14546 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14547 "default-server" "check" setting.
14548
14549no-check-ssl
14550 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14551 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14552 default value.
14553 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14554 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14555
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014556no-send-proxy
14557 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14558 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14559 default value.
14560 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14561 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14562
14563no-send-proxy-v2
14564 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14565 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14566 default value.
14567 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14568 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14569
14570no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14571 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14572 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14573 default value.
14574 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14575 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14576
14577no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14578 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14579 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14580 default value.
14581 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14582 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14583
14584no-ssl
14585 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14586 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14587 default value.
14588 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14589 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14590
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014591 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14592 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14593 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14594
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014595no-ssl-reuse
14596 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14597 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14598 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14599 and for paranoid users.
14600
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014601no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014602 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14603 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014604 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014605
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014606 Supported in default-server: No
14607
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014608no-tls-tickets
14609 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14610 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14611 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014612 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14613 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014614 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14615 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14616 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014617 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014618
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014619no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014620 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014621 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14622 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014623 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14624 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014625 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014626
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014627 Supported in default-server: No
14628
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014629no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014630 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014631 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14632 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014633 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14634 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014635 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014636
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014637 Supported in default-server: No
14638
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014639no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014640 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014641 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14642 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014643 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14644 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014645 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014646
14647 Supported in default-server: No
14648
14649no-tlsv13
14650 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14651 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14652 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14653 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14654 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014655 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014656
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014657 Supported in default-server: No
14658
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014659no-verifyhost
14660 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14661 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14662 default value.
14663 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14664 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014665
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014666no-tfo
14667 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14668 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14669 default value.
14670 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14671 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14672
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014673non-stick
14674 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14675 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14676 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14677
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014678npn <protocols>
14679 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14680 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14681 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014682 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014683 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14684 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14685 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14686
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014687observe <mode>
14688 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14689 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14690 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14691 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14692 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14693 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014694 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014695
14696 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014698on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014699 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14700 Currently, four modes are available:
14701 - fastinter: force fastinter
14702 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14703 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14704 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14705 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14706
14707 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14708
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014709on-marked-down <action>
14710 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14711 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014712 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14713 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14714 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14715 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14716 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14717 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14718 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14719 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014720
14721 Actions are disabled by default
14722
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014723on-marked-up <action>
14724 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14725 Currently one action is available:
14726 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14727 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14728 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14729 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014730 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14731 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014732 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14733 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14734
14735 Actions are disabled by default
14736
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014737pool-low-conn <max>
14738 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14739 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14740 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14741 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14742 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14743 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14744 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14745 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14746 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14747 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014748 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14749 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14750 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14751 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014752
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014753pool-max-conn <max>
14754 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14755 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14756 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14757 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14758 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14759 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14760
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014761pool-purge-delay <delay>
14762 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014763 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014764 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014766port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014767 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014768 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14769 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14770 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14771 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14772 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014773
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014774proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014775 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14776 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14777 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014778 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14779 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14780
14781 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14782 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14783 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14784 also reported (flag=HTX).
14785
14786 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14787 a server line :
14788
14789 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14790 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14791 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14792 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14793
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014794 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014795 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14796
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014797 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014799redir <prefix>
14800 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14801 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14802 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14803 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14804 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14805 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14806 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14807 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014808 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014809 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014810 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14811 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14812 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14813 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14814
14815 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014817rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014818 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14819 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14820 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14821
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014822resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14823 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14824 server.
14825
14826 Available options:
14827
14828 * allow-dup-ip
14829 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14830 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14831 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14832 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14833 For such case, simply enable this option.
14834 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14835
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014836 * ignore-weight
14837 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14838 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14839 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14840
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014841 * prevent-dup-ip
14842 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14843 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14844 same fqdn.
14845 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14846
14847 Example:
14848 backend b_myapp
14849 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14850 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14851 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14852
14853 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14854 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14855 it
14856 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14857 different address
14858
14859 Default value: not set
14860
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014861resolve-prefer <family>
14862 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14863 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14864 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14865 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14866
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014867 Default value: ipv6
14868
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014869 Example:
14870
14871 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014872
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014873resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014874 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014875 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014876 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014877 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14878 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014879 configured network, another address is selected.
14880
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014881 Example:
14882
14883 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014884
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014885resolvers <id>
14886 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14887 hostname.
14888
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014889 Example:
14890
14891 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014892
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014893 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014894
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014895send-proxy
14896 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14897 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14898 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14899 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014900 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14901 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14902 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14903 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014904 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014905 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14906 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14907 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14908 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14909 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014910 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14911 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014912
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014913send-proxy-v2
14914 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14915 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14916 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14917 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014918 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14919 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14920 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14921 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014922
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014923proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014924 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14925 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14926
14927 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14928 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14929 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14930 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14931 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14932 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14933 connection is supported).
14934 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14935 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14936 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14937 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14938 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14939 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14940 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014941
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014942send-proxy-v2-ssl
14943 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14944 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14945 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14946 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14947 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14948 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14949 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014950 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14951 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014952
14953send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14954 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14955 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14956 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14957 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14958 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14959 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14960 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14961 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014962 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14963 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014965slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014966 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14967 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14968 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14969 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14970 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14971 parameters :
14972
14973 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14974 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14975
14976 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14977 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14978 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14979 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14980
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014981 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014982 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14983 seen as failed.
14984
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014985sni <expression>
14986 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14987 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14988 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14989 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014990 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14991 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014992 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014993 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14994 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014995
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014996source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014997source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014998source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014999 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15000 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15001 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15002 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15003
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015004 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15005 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15006 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15007 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15008 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15009 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15010 server.
15011
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015012 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15013 specifying the source address without port(s).
15014
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015015ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015016 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15017 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15018 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15019 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15020 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15021 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015022 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15023 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015024
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015025ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15026 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15027 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15028 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15029
15030ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15031 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15032 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15033 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15034
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015035ssl-reuse
15036 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15037 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15038 default value.
15039 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15040 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15041
15042stick
15043 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15044 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15045 default value.
15046 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15047 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015048
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015049socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015050 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015051 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15052 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15053
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015054tcp-ut <delay>
15055 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015056 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015057 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015058 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015059 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15060 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15061 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15062 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15063 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15064 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15065 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15066 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15067 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15068
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015069tfo
15070 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15071 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15072 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15073 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015074 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015075 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015077track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015078 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15079 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15080 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15081 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015082 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15083
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015084tls-tickets
15085 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15086 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15087 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015088 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15089 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15090 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015091 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015092 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015093
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015094verify [none|required]
15095 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015096 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015097 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15098 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015099 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015100 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15101 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15102 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15103 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15104 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15105 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15106 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15107 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015108
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015109verifyhost <hostname>
15110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015111 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15112 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15113 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15114 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15115 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15116 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15117 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15118 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015120weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015121 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15122 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15123 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015124 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15125 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15126 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15127 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15128 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15129 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015130
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015131ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15132 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15133 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15134 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15135
15136 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15137 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15138 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15139 server ALPN contains it.
15140
15141 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15142 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15143 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15144 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15145
15146 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15147 favor of the ALPN extension.
15148
15149 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015151
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151525.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15153-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015154
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015155HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15156using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015157configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015158This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15159can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15160workload.
15161This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15162resolution at run time.
15163Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15164carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15165
15166
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151675.3.1. Global overview
15168----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015169
15170As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15171different steps of the process life:
15172
15173 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15174 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15175 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15176
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015177 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15178 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015179
15180A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15181 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15182 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15183 resolution to know this new IP.
15184
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015185When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015186HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015187SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15188from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015189will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015190will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015191
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015192A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015193 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015194 first valid response.
15195
15196 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15197 servers return an error.
15198
15199
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152005.3.2. The resolvers section
15201----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015202
15203This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015204HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15205contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015206
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015207When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15208uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15209is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15210answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15211
15212When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015213used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015214
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015215 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15216 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15217 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015218
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015219 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15220 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015221
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015222 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015223 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15224 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015225
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015226For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15227following scenarios are possible:
15228
15229 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15230 ignored
15231
15232 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15233 applied
15234
15235 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15236 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15237
15238 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15239 retries the query with a new type
15240
15241 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15242 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015243
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015244As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015245a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015246<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015247
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015248
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015249resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015250 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015251
15252A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15253
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015254accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015255 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015256 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015257 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15258 by RFC 6891)
15259
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015260 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15261 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15262 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15263 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15264 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15265 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015266
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015267nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15268 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15269 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15270 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15271 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15272 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15273 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15274 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15275 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15276 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015277 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15278
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015279parse-resolv-conf
15280 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15281 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15282 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15283
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015284hold <status> <period>
15285 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15286 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015287 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015288 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015289 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15290 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15291 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15292
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015293 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015294
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015295resolve_retries <nb>
15296 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15297 giving up.
15298 Default value: 3
15299
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015300 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15301 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15302 type.
15303
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015304timeout <event> <time>
15305 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15306 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15307 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015308 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15309 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015310 Default value: 1s
15311 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015312 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015313 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015314 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15315 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15316
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015317 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015318
15319 resolvers mydns
15320 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15321 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015322 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015323 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015324 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015325 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015326 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015327 hold other 30s
15328 hold refused 30s
15329 hold nx 30s
15330 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015331 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015332 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015333
15334
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153356. Cache
15336---------
15337
15338HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15339(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15340RAM.
15341
15342The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15343this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15344
15345If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15346independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15347when we try to allocate a new one.
15348
15349The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15350
15351It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15352"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15353for more details.
15354
15355When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15356replaced by "<CACHE>".
15357
15358
153596.1. Limitation
15360----------------
15361
15362The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15363
15364- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015365- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15366 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15367 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015368- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15369- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015370- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15371 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15372 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015373- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15374 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015375- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15376 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15377 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015378
15379- If the request is not a GET
15380- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15381- If the request contains an Authorization header
15382
15383
153846.2. Setup
15385-----------
15386
15387To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15388the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15389
15390
153916.2.1. Cache section
15392---------------------
15393
15394cache <name>
15395 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15396 size of cache is mandatory.
15397
15398total-max-size <megabytes>
15399 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15400 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15401
15402max-object-size <bytes>
15403 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15404 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15405 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15406
15407max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015408 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015409 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15410 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15411 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15412 default.
15413
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015414process-vary <on/off>
15415 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015416 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15417 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15418 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015419 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015420
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015421max-secondary-entries <number>
15422 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15423 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15424 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15425
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015426
154276.2.2. Proxy section
15428---------------------
15429
15430http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15431 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15432 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15433 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15434 after this one.
15435
15436http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15437 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15438 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15439 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15440 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15441
15442
15443Example:
15444
15445 backend bck1
15446 mode http
15447
15448 http-request cache-use foobar
15449 http-response cache-store foobar
15450 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15451
15452 cache foobar
15453 total-max-size 4
15454 max-age 240
15455
15456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154577. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15458----------------------------------
15459
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015460HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015461client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15462The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15463these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15464but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15465data called patterns.
15466
15467
154687.1. ACL basics
15469---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015470
15471The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15472content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15473from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15474simple :
15475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015476 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015477 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015478 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15479 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15482adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015483
15484In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015487
15488This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15489Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15490and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015491an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15492conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15493as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15494are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015495
15496ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15497'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15498which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15499
15500There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15501performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15504specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15505this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015506methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15507ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508
15509Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15510 - boolean
15511 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15512 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15513 - string
15514 - data block
15515
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015516Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15517converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15518would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15519The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15520which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15521
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015522Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15523keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15524fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15525which are summarized in the table below :
15526
15527 +---------------------+-----------------+
15528 | Sample or converter | Default |
15529 | output type | matching method |
15530 +---------------------+-----------------+
15531 | boolean | bool |
15532 +---------------------+-----------------+
15533 | integer | int |
15534 +---------------------+-----------------+
15535 | ip | ip |
15536 +---------------------+-----------------+
15537 | string | str |
15538 +---------------------+-----------------+
15539 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15540 +---------------------+-----------------+
15541
15542Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15543matching method, see below.
15544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15546 - boolean
15547 - integer or integer range
15548 - IP address / network
15549 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15550 - regular expression
15551 - hex block
15552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015553The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15554
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015555 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15556 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015558 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015559 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015560 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015561 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15564read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15565if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15566lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15567will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15568beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015569a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15571exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15572
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015573The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15574parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15575ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15576a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15577check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15578
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015579The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15580socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15581file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15584loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15585
15586 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15587
15588In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15589the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15590case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15591as well.
15592
15593The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15594sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15595do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15596methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15597is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015598obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15600default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15601that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15602string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15603
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015604The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15605By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15606string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15607resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015608server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015609waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015610flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15611function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15614sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15615be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015616
15617 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15618 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15620 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15621 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15622 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015623
15624 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15625 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015627
15628 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015630
15631 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015632 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015633
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015634 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015635 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15636
15637 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15638 binary or string samples.
15639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15641 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15644 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15645 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15648 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15651 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15654 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015656 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15657 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015658 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15661 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15662 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015663
15664For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15665request, it is possible to do :
15666
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015667 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015668
15669In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15670buffer, one would use the following acl :
15671
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015672 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015673
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015674On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15675possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15676
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015677 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15680criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15681method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15682to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15683criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15684the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015686If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015687the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15688For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15691 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15692 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15693 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015694
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015695
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015696The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15697types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15698combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15699brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15700default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702 +-------------------------------------------------+
15703 | Input sample type |
15704 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015705 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15707 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15708 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015709 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015710 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015711 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015713 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015715 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015717 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015719 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015721 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015723 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015725 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015727 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015729 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15731 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15732 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015733
15734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157357.1.1. Matching booleans
15736------------------------
15737
15738In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15739Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15740When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15741that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15742
15743Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15744return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15745"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15746
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157487.1.2. Matching integers
15749------------------------
15750
15751Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15752enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15753to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15754
15755Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15756matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15757lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015758
15759For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15760unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15761representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15762
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015763As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15764two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15765instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15766ranges and operators.
15767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015768For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015769operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15770Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15771of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015772
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015773Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015774
15775 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15776 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15777 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15778 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15779 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015781For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015782
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015783 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015784
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015785This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15786
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015787 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015788
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157907.1.3. Matching strings
15791-----------------------
15792
15793String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15794different forms :
15795
15796 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015797 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798
15799 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015800 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015801
15802 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15803 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15804
15805 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15806 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15807
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015808 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015809 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15810 matches.
15811
15812 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15813 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15814 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015815
15816String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15817exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15818characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15819string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15820to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015821before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015822
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015823Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15824(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15825Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15826
15827Example:
15828 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15829 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15830
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158327.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15833---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015834
15835Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15836they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15837possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15838passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15839the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015840the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15841match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015842
15843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158447.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15845-------------------------------------
15846
15847It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15848not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15849a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15850to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15851digits may be used upper or lower case.
15852
15853Example :
15854 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015855 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015856
15857
158587.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15859---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015860
15861IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15862netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15863within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015864host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015865difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15866at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15867does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15868parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015869
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015870The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15871abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15872
15873 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15874 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15875 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15876 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15877 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15878 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15879 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15880 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15881
15882Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15883192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15884
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015885IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15886Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15887trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15888IPv6 patterns.
15889
15890HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15891following situations :
15892 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15893 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15894 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15895 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15896 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15897 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15898 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15899 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15900 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15901 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903
159047.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15905----------------------------------
15906
15907Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15908combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15909
15910 - AND (implicit)
15911 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15912 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15919indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15922"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15923requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15924is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15925
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015926 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015927 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15928 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15929 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015930
15931To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15932and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15933
15934 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15935 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15936 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15937 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15938
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015939 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15941 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15942 use_backend www if host_www
15943
15944It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15945expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15946be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15947the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15948
15949 The following rule :
15950
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015951 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015952 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953
15954 Can also be written that way :
15955
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015956 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957
15958It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15959to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15960simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15961sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15962good use is the following :
15963
15964 With named ACLs :
15965
15966 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15967 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15968 monitor fail if site_dead
15969
15970 With anonymous ACLs :
15971
15972 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15973
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015974See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15975keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015976
15977
159787.3. Fetching samples
15979---------------------
15980
15981Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15982against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15983sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15984ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15985of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15986available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15987
15988This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15989Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15990compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15991deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15992
15993The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15994matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15995method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15996indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15997
15998As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15999when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16000mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16001the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16002ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16003
16004Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16005multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16006when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016007incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16008are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16010all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16011
16012Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16013 - name
16014 - name(arg1)
16015 - name(arg1,arg2)
16016
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016017
160187.3.1. Converters
16019-----------------
16020
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016021Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16022of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16023is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16024was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016025has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016026unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16027
16028These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16029sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16030the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016031support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016032
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016033A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16034support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16035supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16036(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16037bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016039The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016040
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001604151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16042 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16043 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16044 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16045 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16046 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16047
16048 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016049 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16050 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016051 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16052 frontend http-in
16053 bind *:8081
16054 default_backend servers
16055 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16056 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16057
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016058add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016059 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016060 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016061 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16062 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016063 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016064 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16065 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16066 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16067 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016068 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016069 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016070
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016071aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16072 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16073 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16074 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16075 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16076 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16077 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16078
16079 Example:
16080 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16081 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16082
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016083and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016084 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016085 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016086 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16087 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016088 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016089 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16090 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16091 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16092 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016093 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016094 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016095
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016096b64dec
16097 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16098 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016099 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16100 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016101
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016102base64
16103 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016104 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016105 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16106 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016107
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016108bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016109 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016110 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016111 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016112 presence of a flag).
16113
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016114bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16115 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16116 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016117 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016118
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016119concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16120 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16121 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16122 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16123 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16124 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16125 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16126 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16127 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16128 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16129 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016130 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016131 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016132 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16133 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016134
16135 Example:
16136 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16137 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16138 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016139 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016140 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16141
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016142cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016143 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16144 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016145
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016146crc32([<avalanche>])
16147 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16148 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16149 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16150 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16151 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16152 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16153 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16154 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16155 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16156 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016157 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16158
16159crc32c([<avalanche>])
16160 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16161 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16162 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16163 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16164 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16165 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16166 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16167 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016168
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016169cut_crlf
16170 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16171 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16172 updated.
16173
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016174da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016175 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16176 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16177 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16178 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016179 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016180 configuration language.
16181
16182 Example:
16183 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016184 bind *:8881
16185 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016186 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016187
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016188debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16189 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16190 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16191 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16192 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16193 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16194 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16195 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16196 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16197 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16198 printable sample types.
16199
16200 Example:
16201 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016202
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016203digest(<algorithm>)
16204 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16205 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16206
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016207 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016208 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16209
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016210div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016211 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16212 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016213 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016214 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16215 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016216 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016217 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16218 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16219 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16220 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016221 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016222 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016223
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016224djb2([<avalanche>])
16225 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16226 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16227 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16228 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16229 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16230 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16231 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016232 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16233 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016234
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016235even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016236 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016237 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16238
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016239field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16240 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16241 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16242 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16243 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16244 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16245 fields.
16246
16247 Example :
16248 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16249 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16250 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16251 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16252 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016253
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016254fix_is_valid
16255 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16256 Information eXchange):
16257
16258 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16259 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016260 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016261 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016262 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016263 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16264 checksum
16265
16266 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16267 the server can be parsed.
16268
16269 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16270 message, false if not.
16271
16272 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16273
16274 Example:
16275 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16276 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16277
16278fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16279 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16280 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16281 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16282 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016283 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016284 added.
16285
16286 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16287 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16288 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16289 fix_is_valid converter.
16290
16291 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16292
16293 Example:
16294 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16295 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16296 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16297 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16298 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16299
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016300hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016301 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016302 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016303 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016304 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016305
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016306hex2i
16307 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016308 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016309
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016310htonl
16311 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16312 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16313 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16314 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16315
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016316hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016317 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16318 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16319 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16320 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16321
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016322 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016323 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16324
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016325http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016326 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16327 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016328 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16329 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16330 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16331 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16332 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16333 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16334 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16335 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016336
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016337iif(<true>,<false>)
16338 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16339 string otherwise.
16340
16341 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016342 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016343
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016344in_table(<table>)
16345 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16346 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16347 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016348 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016349 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16350
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016351ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016352 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016353 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016354 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16355 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16356 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16357 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16358 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016359
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016360json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016361 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016362 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016363 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016364 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16365 of errors:
16366 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16367 bytes, ...)
16368 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16369 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16370
16371 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16372 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16373 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16374 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16375 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16376 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016377 - "ascii" : never fails;
16378 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16379 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016380 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016381 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016382 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16383 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16384
16385 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016386 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016387
16388 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016389 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016390 capture request header user-agent len 150
16391 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016392
16393 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16394 GET / HTTP/1.0
16395 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16396
16397 Output log:
16398 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16399
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016400json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16401 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16402 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16403 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16404 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16405
16406 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16407 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16408
16409 Example:
16410 # get a integer value from the request body
16411 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16412 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16413
16414 # get a key with '.' in the name
16415 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16416 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16417
16418 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16419 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16420
16421 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16422 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16423
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016424language(<value>[,<default>])
16425 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16426 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16427 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16428 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16429 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16430 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16431 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16432 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16433 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016434 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016435 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16436 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016437
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016438 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016439
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016440 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16441 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016442
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016443 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16444 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16445 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16446 use_backend spanish if es
16447 use_backend french if fr
16448 use_backend english if en
16449 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016450
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016451length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016452 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16453 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16454 type. The result is of type integer.
16455
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016456lower
16457 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16458 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16459 type. The result is of type string.
16460
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016461ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16462 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16463 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16464 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16465 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16466 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16467 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16468
16469 Example :
16470
16471 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016472 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016473 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16474
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016475ltrim(<chars>)
16476 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16477 representation of the input sample.
16478
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016479map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16480map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16481map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16482 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16483 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16484 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16485 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16486 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16487 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16488 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16489 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016490
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016491 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16492 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16493 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016494
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016495 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016496 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016497
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016498 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16499 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16500 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16501 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016502 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16503 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016504 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16505 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16506 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16507 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16508 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16509 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16510 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16511 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016512 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16513 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16514 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016515 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16516 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16517 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16518 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16519 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016520
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016521 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16522 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16523 the corresponding match text.
16524
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016525 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16526 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16527 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16528 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16529 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016530
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016531 Example :
16532
16533 # this is a comment and is ignored
16534 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16535 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16536 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16537 | | | `---------- value
16538 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16539 | `---------------------------- key
16540 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16541
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016542mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016543 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16544 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016545 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016546 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016547 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016548 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16549 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16550 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16551 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016552 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016553 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016554
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016555mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016556 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16557 <packettype>.
16558 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16559 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16560 from.
16561 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16562 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16563 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16564
16565 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16566 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16567 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16568 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16569
16570 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16571 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16572 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16573 packets only):
16574 17: Session Expiry Interval
16575 33: Receive Maximum
16576 39: Maximum Packet Size
16577 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16578 25: Request Response Information
16579 23: Request Problem Information
16580 21: Authentication Method
16581 22: Authentication Data
16582 18: Will Delay Interval
16583 1: Payload Format Indicator
16584 2: Message Expiry Interval
16585 3: Content Type
16586 8: Response Topic
16587 9: Correlation Data
16588 Not supported yet:
16589 38: User Property
16590
16591 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16592 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16593 packets only):
16594 17: Session Expiry Interval
16595 33: Receive Maximum
16596 36: Maximum QoS
16597 37: Retain Available
16598 39: Maximum Packet Size
16599 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16600 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16601 31: Reason String
16602 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16603 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16604 42: Shared Subscription Available
16605 19: Server Keep Alive
16606 26: Response Information
16607 28: Server Reference
16608 21: Authentication Method
16609 22: Authentication Data
16610 Not supported yet:
16611 38: User Property
16612
16613 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16614 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16615 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16616 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16617
16618 Example:
16619
16620 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16621 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16622 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16623 if data_in_buffer
16624 # do the same as above
16625 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16626 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16627 if data_in_buffer
16628
16629mqtt_is_valid
16630 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16631
16632 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16633 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16634 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16635 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16636
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016637 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16638
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016639 Example:
16640
16641 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016642 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016643
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016644mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016645 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016646 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16647 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016648 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016649 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016650 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016651 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16652 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16653 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16654 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016655 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016656 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016657
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016658nbsrv
16659 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16660 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16661 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16662 map lookup.
16663
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016664neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016665 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16666 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16667 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16668 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016669
16670not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016671 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016672 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016673 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016674 absence of a flag).
16675
16676odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016677 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016678 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16679
16680or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016681 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016682 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016683 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16684 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016685 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016686 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16687 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16688 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16689 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016690 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016691 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016692
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016693protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16694 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16695 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16696 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16697 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16698 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16699 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16700 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16701 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16702 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16703 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16704 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16705
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016706regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016707 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16708 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16709 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16710 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16711 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16712 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16713 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16714 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16715 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016716 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16717 of characters with other ones.
16718
16719 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16720 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16721 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16722 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16723 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16724 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016725
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016726 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016727
16728 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16729 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16730 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016731 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016732
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016733 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16734 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16735
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016736 # capture groups and backreferences
16737 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016738 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016739 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16740
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016741capture-req(<id>)
16742 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16743 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16744
16745 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016746 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16747 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016748
16749capture-res(<id>)
16750 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16751 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16752
16753 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016754 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16755 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016756
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016757rtrim(<chars>)
16758 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16759 of the input sample.
16760
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016761sdbm([<avalanche>])
16762 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16763 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16764 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16765 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16766 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16767 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16768 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016769 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16770 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016771
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016772secure_memcmp(<var>)
16773 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16774 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16775 match.
16776
16777 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16778 performed in constant time.
16779
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016780 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016781 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16782
16783 Example :
16784
16785 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16786 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16787 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16788 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16789
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016790set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016791 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16792 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16793 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016794 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016795 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16796 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016797 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016798 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16799 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016800 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016801 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016802
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016803sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016804 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016805 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16806
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016807sha2([<bits>])
16808 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16809 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16810
16811 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16812 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16813
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016814 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016815 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16816
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016817srv_queue
16818 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16819 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16820 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16821 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16822 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16823
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016824strcmp(<var>)
16825 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16826 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16827 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16828 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16829 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16830 shorter).
16831
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016832 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16833 strings in constant time.
16834
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016835 Example :
16836
16837 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16838 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16839 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16840
16841
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016842sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016843 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16844 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016845 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016846 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16847 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016848 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016849 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16850 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016851 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016852 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16853 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016854 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016855 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016856
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016857table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16858 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16859 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16860 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16861 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16862 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16863 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16864
16865
16866table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16867 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16868 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16869 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16870 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16871 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16872 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16873
16874table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016878 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16879 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16880
16881table_conn_cur(<table>)
16882 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16883 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16884 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16885 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16886 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16887
16888table_conn_rate(<table>)
16889 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16890 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16891 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16892 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16893 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16894
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016895table_gpt0(<table>)
16896 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16897 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16898 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16899 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16900 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16901
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016902table_gpc0(<table>)
16903 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16904 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16905 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16906 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16907 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16908
16909table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16913 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16914 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16915 sample fetch keyword.
16916
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016917table_gpc1(<table>)
16918 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16919 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16920 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16921 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16922 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16923
16924table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16925 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16926 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16927 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16928 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16929 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16930 sample fetch keyword.
16931
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016932table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16933 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16934 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016935 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016936 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16937 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16938
16939table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16940 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16941 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16942 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16943 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16944 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16945 keyword.
16946
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016947table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16950 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16951 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16952 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16953
16954table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16955 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16956 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16957 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16958 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16959 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16960 keyword.
16961
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016962table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16963 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16964 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016965 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016966 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16967 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16968
16969table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16970 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16971 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16972 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16973 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16974 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16975 keyword.
16976
16977table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16978 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16979 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016980 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016981 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16982 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16983 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16984 keyword.
16985
16986table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16987 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16988 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016989 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016990 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16991 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16992 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16993 keyword.
16994
16995table_server_id(<table>)
16996 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16997 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16998 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16999 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17000 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17001 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17002
17003table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017006 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017007 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17008 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17009 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17010 keyword.
17011
17012table_sess_rate(<table>)
17013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17016 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17017 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17018 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17019 keyword.
17020
17021table_trackers(<table>)
17022 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17023 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17024 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17025 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17026 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17027 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17028 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17029 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17030 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17031 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17032
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017033ub64dec
17034 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17035 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17036 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17037
17038 Example:
17039 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17040 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17041
17042ub64enc
17043 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17044
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017045upper
17046 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17047 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17048 type. The result is of type string.
17049
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017050url_dec([<in_form>])
17051 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17052 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17053 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17054 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17055 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17056 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017057
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017058url_enc([<enc_type>])
17059 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17060 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17061 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17062 optional argument is here for future changes.
17063
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017064ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017065 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017066 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17067 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17068 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017069 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17070 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17071 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17072 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017073 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017074 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17075 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017076
17077 Example:
17078 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17079 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17080
17081 message Point {
17082 int32 latitude = 1;
17083 int32 longitude = 2;
17084 }
17085
17086 message PPoint {
17087 Point point = 59;
17088 }
17089
17090 message Rectangle {
17091 // One corner of the rectangle.
17092 PPoint lo = 48;
17093 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17094 PPoint hi = 49;
17095 }
17096
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017097 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17098 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17099 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017100
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017101 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17102 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017103 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017104 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17105
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017106 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017107
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017108 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017109
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017110 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17111 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17112 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017113
17114 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17115 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17116 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17117
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017118 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17119 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17120 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017121
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017122
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017123unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017124 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17125 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17126 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17127 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17128 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17129 response),
17130 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17131 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17132 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17133 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17134
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017135utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17136 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17137 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17138 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17139 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17140 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17141 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17142
17143 Example :
17144
17145 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017146 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017147 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17148
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017149word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17150 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17151 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17152 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017153 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017154 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17155 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17156
17157 Example :
17158 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17159 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17160 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17161 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17162 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017163 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017164
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017165wt6([<avalanche>])
17166 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17167 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17168 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17169 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17170 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17171 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17172 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017173 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17174 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017175
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017176xor(<value>)
17177 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017178 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017179 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017180 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017181 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017182 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17183 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017184 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017185 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17186 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017187 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017188 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017189
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017190xxh3([<seed>])
17191 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17192 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17193 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17194 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17195 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17196 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17197 considered as cryptographically secure.
17198
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017199xxh32([<seed>])
17200 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17201 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17202 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17203 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17204 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17205 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17206 as cryptographically secure.
17207
17208xxh64([<seed>])
17209 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17210 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17211 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17212 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17213 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17214 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17215 as cryptographically secure.
17216
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017217
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172187.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017219--------------------------------------------
17220
17221A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17222not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17223"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17224The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17225
17226always_false : boolean
17227 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17228 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17229
17230always_true : boolean
17231 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17232 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17233
17234avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017235 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017236 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17237 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17238 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17239 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17240 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17241 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17242 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17243 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17244 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17245 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17246 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17247 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17248 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017250be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017251 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17252 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17253 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17254 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017255 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17256
17257be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17258 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17259 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17260 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17261 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17262 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017263 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17264 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017265
17266 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17267 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17268 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017270be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17271 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17272 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17273 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017274 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017275 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17276 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017277
17278 Example :
17279 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17280 backend dynamic
17281 mode http
17282 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17283 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017284
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017285bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017286 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17287 of the string.
17288
17289bool(<bool>) : bool
17290 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17291 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017293connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17294 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017295 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017296 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17297 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017298
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017299 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017300 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017301 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17302
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017303 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17304 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017305
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017306 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017307 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017308 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017309 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017310 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017311 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017312 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017313
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017314 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17315 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017316 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017317 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017318
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017319cpu_calls : integer
17320 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17321 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17322 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17323 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17324 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17325 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17326
17327cpu_ns_avg : integer
17328 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17329 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17330 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17331 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17332 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17333 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17334 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17335 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17336 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17337 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17338 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17339
17340cpu_ns_tot : integer
17341 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17342 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17343 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17344 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17345 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17346 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17347 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17348 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17349 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17350 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17351 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17352 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17353 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17354
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017355date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017356 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017357
17358 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17359 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17360 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017361 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17362
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017363 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17364 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17365 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17366 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17367 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17368
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017369 Example :
17370
17371 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17372 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017373
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017374 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17375 # millisecond granularity
17376 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17377
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017378date_us : integer
17379 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17380 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17381 from the same timeval structure.
17382
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017383distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17384 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17385 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17386 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17387 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017388 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017389 list of supported tokens.
17390
17391distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17392 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17393 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17394 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17395 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017396 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017397 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17398 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17399 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17400 supported tokens.
17401
17402 Example :
17403 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17404 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17405 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17406 # send large files to the big farm
17407 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17408
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017409env(<name>) : string
17410 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17411 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17412 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17413 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17414 certain way.
17415
17416 Examples :
17417 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17418 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17419
17420 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017421 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017423fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17424 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017425 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17426 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017427 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17428 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017429 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017430 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17431 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017432
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017433fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17434 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17435 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17436 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017438fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17439 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17440 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17441 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17442 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17443 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17444 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17445 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17446 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017447
17448 Example :
17449 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17450 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17451 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17452 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17453 frontend mail
17454 bind :25
17455 mode tcp
17456 maxconn 100
17457 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17458 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17459 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17460 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017461
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017462hostname : string
17463 Returns the system hostname.
17464
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017465int(<integer>) : signed integer
17466 Returns a signed integer.
17467
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017468ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17469 Returns an ipv4.
17470
17471ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17472 Returns an ipv6.
17473
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017474lat_ns_avg : integer
17475 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17476 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17477 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17478 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17479 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17480 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17481 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17482 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17483 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017484 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17485 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17486 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17487 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17488 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17489 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017490
17491lat_ns_tot : integer
17492 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17493 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17494 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17495 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17496 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17497 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17498 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17499 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17500 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017501 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17502 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17503 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17504 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17505 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017506 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17507 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17508 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17509 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17510 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17511 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17512
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017513meth(<method>) : method
17514 Returns a method.
17515
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017516nbproc : integer
17517 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17518 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17519 and debugging purposes.
17520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017521nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17522 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17523 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17524 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017525 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17526 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17527 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017528
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017529prio_class : integer
17530 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17531 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17532 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17533
17534prio_offset : integer
17535 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17536 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17537 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17538 set-priority-offset".
17539
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017540proc : integer
17541 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17542 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17543 debugging purposes.
17544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017545queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017546 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17547 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17548 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017549 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17550 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17551 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17552 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17553 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17554
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017555rand([<range>]) : integer
17556 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17557 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17558 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17559 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17560 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017562srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17563 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17564 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17565 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17566 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17567 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017568 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17569 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17570
17571srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17572 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17573 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17574 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17575 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17576 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17577 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17578 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17579
17580 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17581 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017582
17583srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17584 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17585 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17586 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017587 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017588 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17589 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17590 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17591
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017592srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17593 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17594 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17595 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17596 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17597 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17598 fetch methods.
17599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017600srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17601 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17602 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017603 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017604 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17605 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017606 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017607 overloading servers).
17608
17609 Example :
17610 # Redirect to a separate back
17611 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17612 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17613 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17614
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017615srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017616 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17617 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17618 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17619
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017620srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017621 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17622 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17623 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17624
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017625srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017626 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17627 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17628 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17629
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017630stopping : boolean
17631 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17632 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17633 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17634
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017635str(<string>) : string
17636 Returns a string.
17637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017638table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17639 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17640 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17641
17642table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17643 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17644 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17645 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17646
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017647thread : integer
17648 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17649 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17650 and debugging purposes.
17651
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017652uuid([<version>]) : string
17653 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17654 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17655 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17656
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017657var(<var-name>) : undefined
17658 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017659 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17660 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017661 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017662 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17663 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017664 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017665 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17666 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017667 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017668 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017669
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176707.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017671----------------------------------
17672
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017673The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017674closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17675methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17676sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17677TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017678the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17679counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017680"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17681used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17682can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17683Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17684table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17685tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17686currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017687
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017688bc_dst : ip
17689 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17690 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17691 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17692 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17693
17694bc_dst_port : integer
17695 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017696 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017697
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017698bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017699 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17700 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17701 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17702
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017703bc_src : ip
17704 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017705 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017706 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17707 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17708
17709bc_src_port : integer
17710 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017711 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017713be_id : integer
17714 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017715 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17716 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017717
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017718be_name : string
17719 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017720 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17721 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017722
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017723be_server_timeout : integer
17724 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17725 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17726 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17727
17728be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17729 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17730 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17731 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17732
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017733cur_server_timeout : integer
17734 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17735 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17736 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17737
17738cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17739 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17740 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17741 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017743dst : ip
17744 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17745 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17746 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17747 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017748 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17749 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17750 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17751 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17752 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17753 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017754
17755dst_conn : integer
17756 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17757 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17758 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17759 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17760 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17761 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17762 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17763 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017764
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017765dst_is_local : boolean
17766 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17767 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17768 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17769 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017770 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017771 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17772 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17773 it only once per connection.
17774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017775dst_port : integer
17776 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17777 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17778 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17779 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17780 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17781 an HTTP header.
17782
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017783fc_fackets : integer
17784 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17785 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17786 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17787 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17788
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017789fc_http_major : integer
17790 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17791 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17792 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17793
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017794fc_lost : integer
17795 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17796 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17797 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17798 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17799
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017800fc_pp_authority : string
17801 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17802 if any.
17803
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017804fc_pp_unique_id : string
17805 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17806 if any.
17807
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017808fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17809 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17810 header.
17811
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017812fc_reordering : integer
17813 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17814 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17815 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17816 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17817
17818fc_retrans : integer
17819 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17820 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17821 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17822 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17823
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017824fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17825 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17826 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17827 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17828 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17829 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17830 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17831
17832fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17833 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17834 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17835 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17836 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17837 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17838 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17839
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017840fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017841 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17842 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17843 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17844 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17845
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017846
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017847fc_unacked : integer
17848 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17849 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17850 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17851 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017852
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017853fe_defbe : string
17854 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17855 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017857fe_id : integer
17858 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017859 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017860 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17861
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017862fe_name : string
17863 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17864 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17865 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17866
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017867fe_client_timeout : integer
17868 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17869 current frontend.
17870
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017871sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017872sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17873sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17874sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017875 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17876 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17877 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17878
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017879sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017880sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17881sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17882sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017883 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17884 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17885 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17886
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017887sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017888sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17889sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17890sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017891 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17892 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017893 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17894 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17895 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017896
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017897 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017898 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17899 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017900 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17901 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17902 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017903 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17904 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17905
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017906sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17907sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17908sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17909sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17910 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17911 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17912 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17913 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17914 when a first ACL was verified.
17915
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017916sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017917sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17918sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17919sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017920 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017921 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17922
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017923sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017924sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17925sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17926sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017927 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17928 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17929 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17930
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017931sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017932sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17933sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17934sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017935 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17936 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17937 See also src_conn_rate.
17938
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017939sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017940sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17941sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17942sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017943 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017944 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017945
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017946sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17947sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17948sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17949sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17950 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17951 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17952
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017953sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17954sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17955sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17956sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17957 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17958 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17959
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017960sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017961sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17962sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17963sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017964 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17965 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17966 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017967 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17968 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17969 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017970
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017971sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17972sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17973sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17974sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17975 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17976 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17977 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17978 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17979 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17980 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17981
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017982sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017983sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17984sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17985sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017986 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017987 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17988 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17989
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017990sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017991sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17992sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17993sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017994 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17995 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17996 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17997 src_http_err_rate.
17998
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017999sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18000sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18001sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18002sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18003 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18004 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18005 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18006
18007sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18008sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18009sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18010sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18011 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18012 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18013 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18014 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18015
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018016sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018017sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18018sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18019sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018020 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018021 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18022 src_http_req_cnt.
18023
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018024sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018025sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18026sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18027sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018028 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18029 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18030 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18031 src_http_req_rate.
18032
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018033sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018034sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18035sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18036sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018037 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018038 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18039 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18040 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18041 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018042
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018043 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018044 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18045 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018046 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18047
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018048sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18049sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18050sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18051sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18052 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18053 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18054 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18055 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18056 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18057
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018058sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018059sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18060sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18061sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018062 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18063 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18064 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018066sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018067sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18068sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18069sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018070 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18071 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18072 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018074sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018075sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18076sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18077sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018078 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018079 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18080 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18081 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018082 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018083 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18084
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018085sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018086sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18087sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18088sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018089 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18090 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18091 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18092 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18093 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018094 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018095
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018096sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018097sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18098sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18099sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018100 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18101 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18102 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018104sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018105sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18106sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18107sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018108 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18109 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018110 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018111 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18112 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018113 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18114 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18115 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018117so_id : integer
18118 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18119 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18120 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018121
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018122so_name : string
18123 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18124 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18125 strings instead of integers.
18126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018127src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018128 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018129 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18130 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18131 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018132 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18133 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18134 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018135 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18136 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18137 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18138 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18139 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18140 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18141 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018142
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018143 Example:
18144 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18145 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018147src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18148 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18149 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18150 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018151 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018153src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18154 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18155 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018156 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018157 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018159src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18160 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18161 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18162 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18163 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18164 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18165 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018166
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018167 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018168 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18169 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18170 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18171 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018172 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018173 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18174 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18175
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018176src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18177 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18178 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18179 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18180 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18181 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18182 was verified.
18183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018184src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018185 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018186 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018187 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018188 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018190src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018191 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018192 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18193 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018194 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018196src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18197 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18198 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18199 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018200 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018202src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018203 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018204 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018205 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018206 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018207
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018208src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18209 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18210 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18211 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18212 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18213
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018214src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18215 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18216 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18217 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18218 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018220src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018221 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018222 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018223 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18224 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018225 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18226 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18227 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018228
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018229src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18230 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18231 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18232 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18233 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18234 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18235 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18236 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018238src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018239 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018240 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018241 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018242 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018243 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018245src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18246 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18247 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18248 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18249 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018250 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018251
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018252src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18253 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18254 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018255 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018256 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18257 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18258
18259src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18260 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18261 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18262 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18263 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18264 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18265 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018267src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018268 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018269 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18270 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018271 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18274 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18275 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18276 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018277 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018278 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018280src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18281 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18282 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18283 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018284 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18286 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018287
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018288 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018289 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018290 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018291 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018292
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018293src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18294 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18295 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18296 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18297 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18298 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18299 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18300
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018301src_is_local : boolean
18302 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18303 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18304 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18305 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018306 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018307 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18308 once per connection.
18309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018310src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018311 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18312 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18313 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18314 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18315 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018317src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018318 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18319 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18320 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18321 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18322 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018324src_port : integer
18325 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18326 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18327 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18328 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018330src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018331 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018332 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18333 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18334 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018335 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018337src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18338 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18339 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18340 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18341 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018342 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018344src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18345 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18346 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18347 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18348 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18349 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18350 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18351 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18352 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018353
18354 Example :
18355 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18356 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18357 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18358 listen ssh
18359 bind :22
18360 mode tcp
18361 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018362 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018363 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018364 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366srv_id : integer
18367 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18368 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018369 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018370
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018371srv_name : string
18372 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18373 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018374 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018375
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200183767.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018377----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018378
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018379The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018380closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18381when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18382usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018383future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018384
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001838551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18386 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18387 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18388 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18389 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18390 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18391
18392 Example :
18393 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18394 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18395 # the request.
18396 frontend http-in
18397 bind *:8081
18398 default_backend servers
18399 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18400 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18401
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018402ssl_bc : boolean
18403 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18404 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018405 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18406 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018407
18408ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18409 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018410 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18411 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018412
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018413ssl_bc_alpn : string
18414 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18415 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018416 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018417 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18418 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18419 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18420 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18421 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018422 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18423 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018424
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018425ssl_bc_cipher : string
18426 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018427 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18428 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018429
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018430ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18431 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18432 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18433 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018434 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018435
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018436ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18437 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18438 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018439 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18440 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018441
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018442ssl_bc_npn : string
18443 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18444 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018445 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018446 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18447 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18448 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18449 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018450 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18451 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018452
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018453ssl_bc_protocol : string
18454 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018455 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18456 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018457
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018458ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018459 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018460 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018461 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18462 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018463
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018464ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18465 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18466 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18467 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018468 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018469
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018470ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18471 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18472 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018473 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18474 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018475
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018476ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18477 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18478 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18479 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018480 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018481
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018482ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18483 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018484 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18485 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018487ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18488 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18489 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18490 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18491 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18492 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018494ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18495 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18496 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18497 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18498 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018499
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018500ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018501 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18502 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18503 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018504 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018505 does not support resumed sessions.
18506
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018507ssl_c_der : binary
18508 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18509 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18510 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018512ssl_c_err : integer
18513 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18514 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18515 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18516 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18517 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018518
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018519ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018520 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18521 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18522 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18523 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18524 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18525 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18526 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18527 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018528 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18529 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18530 LDAP v3.
18531 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18532 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018534ssl_c_key_alg : string
18535 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18536 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18537 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018539ssl_c_notafter : string
18540 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18541 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18542 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018544ssl_c_notbefore : string
18545 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18546 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18547 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018548
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018549ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018550 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18551 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18552 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18553 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18554 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18555 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18556 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18557 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018558 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18559 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18560 LDAP v3.
18561 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18562 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018564ssl_c_serial : binary
18565 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18566 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18567 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018569ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18570 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18571 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18572 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018573 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18574 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18575
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018576 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018577 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018579ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18580 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18581 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18582 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018584ssl_c_used : boolean
18585 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18586 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018588ssl_c_verify : integer
18589 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18590 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18591 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18592 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018594ssl_c_version : integer
18595 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18596 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018597
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018598ssl_f_der : binary
18599 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18600 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18601 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18602
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018603ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018604 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18605 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18606 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18607 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018608 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018609 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18610 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18611 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018612 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18613 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18614 LDAP v3.
18615 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18616 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018618ssl_f_key_alg : string
18619 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18620 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18621 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018623ssl_f_notafter : string
18624 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18625 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18626 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018628ssl_f_notbefore : string
18629 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18630 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18631 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018632
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018633ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018634 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18635 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18636 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18637 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18638 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18639 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18640 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18641 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018642 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18643 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18644 LDAP v3.
18645 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18646 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018648ssl_f_serial : binary
18649 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18650 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18651 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018652
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018653ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18654 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18655 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18656 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018658ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18659 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18660 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18661 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018663ssl_f_version : integer
18664 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18665 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18666
18667ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018668 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18669 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18670 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018672 Example :
18673 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18674 listen http-https
18675 bind :80
18676 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18677 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18678
18679ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18680 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18681 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18682
18683ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018684 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018685 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018686 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018687 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18688 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18689 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18690 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18691 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18692 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018694ssl_fc_cipher : string
18695 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18696 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018697
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018698ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18699 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18700 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018701 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018702
18703ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18704 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18705 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018706 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018707
18708ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18709 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18710 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18711 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018712 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018713 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018714
18715ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18716 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18717 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018718 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018719
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018720ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18721 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18722 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18723 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18724
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018725ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18726 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18727 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18728 transport layer.
18729 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18730 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18731 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18732 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18733
18734ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18735 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18736 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18737 transport layer.
18738 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18739 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18740 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18741 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18742
18743ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18744 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18745 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18746 transport layer.
18747 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18748 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18749 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18750 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18751
18752ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18753 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18754 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18755 transport layer.
18756 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18757 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18758 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18759 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18760
18761ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18762 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18763 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18764 transport layer.
18765 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18766 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18767 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18768 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018770ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018771 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18772 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018773 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18774 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18775 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18776 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018777
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018778ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18779 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18780 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18781 wait until the handshake happened.
18782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018783ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18784 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018785 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18786 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018787 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018788 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018789
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018790ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018791 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018792 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18793 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018795ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018796 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018797 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018798 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18799 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18800 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18801 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18802 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18803 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018805ssl_fc_protocol : string
18806 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18807 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018808
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018809ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018810 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018811 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018812 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018813
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018814ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18815 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18816 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18817 transport layer.
18818 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18819 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18820 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18821 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18822
18823ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18824 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18825 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18826 transport layer.
18827 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18828 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18829 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18830 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18831
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018832ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18833 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18834 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18835 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18838 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18839 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18840 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18841 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018842
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018843ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18844 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18845 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18846 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18847 BoringSSL.
18848
18849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018850ssl_fc_sni : string
18851 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18852 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018853 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018854 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18855 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18856
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018857 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018858 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018859 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018860 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018861 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018863 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018864 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18865 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018867ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18868 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18869 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018870
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018871ssl_s_der : binary
18872 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18873 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18874 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18875
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018876ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18877 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18878 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18879 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018880 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018881 does not support resumed sessions.
18882
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018883ssl_s_key_alg : string
18884 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18885 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18886 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18887
18888ssl_s_notafter : string
18889 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18890 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18891 transport layer.
18892
18893ssl_s_notbefore : string
18894 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18895 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18896 transport layer.
18897
18898ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18899 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18900 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18901 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18902 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18903 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18904 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018905 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18906 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018907 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18908 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18909 LDAP v3.
18910 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18911 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18912
18913ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18914 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18915 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18916 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18917 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18918 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18919 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018920 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18921 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018922 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18923 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18924 LDAP v3.
18925 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18926 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18927
18928ssl_s_serial : binary
18929 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18930 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18931 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18932
18933ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18934 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18935 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18936 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18937
18938ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18939 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18940 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18941 layer.
18942
18943ssl_s_version : integer
18944 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18945 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018946
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189477.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018948------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018950Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18951sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18952only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18953For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18954be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18955can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18956sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18957for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18958content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018959
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018960Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18961 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018962 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018963 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18964 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18965 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18966 sample expression). So be careful.
18967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018968payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018969 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018970 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18971 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018973payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18974 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018975 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018976 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018978req.len : integer
18979req_len : integer (deprecated)
18980 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18981 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18982 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18983 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18984 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018985 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018986 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18987 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018989req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18990 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018991 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18992 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18993 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18994 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018995
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018996 ACL derivatives :
18997 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018999req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19000 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19001 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19002 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19003 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019004
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019005 ACL derivatives :
19006 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019008 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019010req.proto_http : boolean
19011req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19012 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19013 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19014 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19015 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19016 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19017 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19018 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019020 Example:
19021 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19022 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19023 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019024 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019026req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19027rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19028 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19029 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19030 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19031 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19032 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19033 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19034 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019036 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19037 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19038 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19039 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19040 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19041 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019043 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019044 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019046 Example :
19047 listen tse-farm
19048 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19049 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19050 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19051 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19052 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19053 persist rdp-cookie
19054 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19055 # This is only useful makes sense if
19056 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19057 stick-table type string size 204800
19058 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19059 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19060 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019062 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019063 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019065req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19066rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19067 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19068 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19069 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19070 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019072 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019073 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019074
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019075req.ssl_alpn : string
19076 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19077 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19078 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19079 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19080 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19081 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019082 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019083
19084 Examples :
19085 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19086 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019087 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019088 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019089 default_backend bk_default
19090
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019091req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19092 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19093 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019094 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19095 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19096 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19097 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19098 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019100req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19101req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19102 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19103 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19104 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19105 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19106 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19107 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19108 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019110req.ssl_sni : string
19111req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19112 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19113 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19114 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19115 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19116 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019117 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19118 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19119 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19120 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19121 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19122 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19123 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19124 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19125 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019127 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019128 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019130 Examples :
19131 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19132 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019133 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019134 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019135 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019136
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019137req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19138 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19139 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19140 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19141 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19142 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19143 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19144 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19145 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19146 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019148req.ssl_ver : integer
19149req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19150 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19151 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19152 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19153 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19154 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19155 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19156 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019157 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019158 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019160 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019161 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019162
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019163res.len : integer
19164 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19165 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19166 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19167 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19168 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019169 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019170 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019171 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019173res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19174 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019175 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019176 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019177 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019178 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019180res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19181 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19182 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19183 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019184 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19185 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019187 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019188
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019189res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19190rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19191 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19192 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19193 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19194 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19195 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19196 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19197 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019199wait_end : boolean
19200 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19201 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019202 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019203 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19204 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019205 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019206 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19207 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019209 Examples :
19210 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19211 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19212 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019214 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19215 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19216 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19217 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19218 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19219 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19220 tcp-request content reject
19221
19222
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192237.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019224--------------------------------------
19225
19226It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19227This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19228data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19229its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19230HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19231content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19232to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19233more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19234response are indexed.
19235
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019236Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19237 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19238 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19239 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19240 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19241 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19242 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019244base : string
19245 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19246 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19247 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19248 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19249 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19250 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19251 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19252 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19253
19254 ACL derivatives :
19255 base : exact string match
19256 base_beg : prefix match
19257 base_dir : subdir match
19258 base_dom : domain match
19259 base_end : suffix match
19260 base_len : length match
19261 base_reg : regex match
19262 base_sub : substring match
19263
19264base32 : integer
19265 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19266 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19267 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019268 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19269 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19270 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019271
19272base32+src : binary
19273 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19274 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19275 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19276 per-URL counters.
19277
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019278baseq : string
19279 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19280 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19281 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19282 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19283
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019284capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19285 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19286 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19287 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19288
19289capture.req.method : string
19290 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19291 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19292 because it's allocated.
19293
19294capture.req.uri : string
19295 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19296 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19297 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19298 allocated.
19299
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019300capture.req.ver : string
19301 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19302 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19303 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19304
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019305capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19306 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19307 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19308 The first entry is an index of 0.
19309 See also: "capture response header"
19310
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019311capture.res.ver : string
19312 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19313 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19314 persistent flag.
19315
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019316req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019317 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19318 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19319 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019320
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019321req.body_param([<name>) : string
19322 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19323 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19324 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19325 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19326 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19327 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19328 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19329 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19330 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19331 given.
19332
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019333req.body_len : integer
19334 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19335 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019336 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19337 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019338
19339req.body_size : integer
19340 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019341 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19342 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019344req.cook([<name>]) : string
19345cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19346 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19347 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19348 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19349 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19350 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19351 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19352 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19353 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19354
19355 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019356 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19357 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19358 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19359 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19360 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19361 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19362 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19363 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019365req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19366cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19367 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19368 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019370req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19371cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19372 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19373 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19374 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19375 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019377cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19378 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19379 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19380 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19381 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019382 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019383 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19384 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19385 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19386 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019388hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19389 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19390 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19391 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19392 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019393 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019395req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019396 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19397 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19398 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19399 with headers such as User-Agent.
19400
19401 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19402 found.
19403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019404 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19405 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19406 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019407 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019409req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19410 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19411 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019412 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19413 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019415req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019416 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19417 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19418 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19419 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19420 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19421 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19422 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19423
19424 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19425 found.
19426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019427 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19428 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19429 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019430 with -1 being the last one.
19431
19432 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19433 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019435 ACL derivatives :
19436 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19437 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19438 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19439 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19440 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19441 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19442 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19443 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19444
19445req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19446hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19447 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19448 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019449 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19450 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19451 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19452
19453 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19454 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19455 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19456
19457 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019458
19459req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19460hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19461 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19462 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19463 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019464 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19465 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19466 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19467 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19468 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019469
19470 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19471
19472 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019473
19474req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19475hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19476 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19477 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19478 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019479
19480 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19481
19482 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019483
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019484req.hdrs : string
19485 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19486 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19487 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19488 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19489
19490req.hdrs_bin : binary
19491 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19492 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19493 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19494 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19495 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19496 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19497
19498 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019499
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019500 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19501 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019503http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19504 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19505 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19506 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19507 basic auth is supported.
19508
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019509http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19510 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19511 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19512 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19513 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019514 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19515 basic auth is supported.
19516
19517 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019518 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19519 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19520 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19521 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019522
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019523http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019524 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19525 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19526 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019527
19528http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019529 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19530 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19531 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019532
19533http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019534 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19535 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19536 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019538http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019539 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19540 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019541 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19542 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019544method : integer + string
19545 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19546 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19547 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19548 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19549 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19550 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19551 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019553 ACL derivatives :
19554 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019556 Example :
19557 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19558 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19559 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019561path : string
19562 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19563 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19564 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19565 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19566 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019567 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019568 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019570 ACL derivatives :
19571 path : exact string match
19572 path_beg : prefix match
19573 path_dir : subdir match
19574 path_dom : domain match
19575 path_end : suffix match
19576 path_len : length match
19577 path_reg : regex match
19578 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019579
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019580pathq : string
19581 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19582 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19583 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19584 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19585 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19586 result in both cases.
19587
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019588query : string
19589 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19590 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19591 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19592 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019593 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019594 which stops before the question mark.
19595
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019596req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19597 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19598 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19599 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19600 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019602req.ver : string
19603req_ver : string (deprecated)
19604 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19605 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19606 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019608 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019609 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019610
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019611res.body : binary
19612 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19613 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019614 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19615
19616 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019617
19618res.body_len : integer
19619 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19620 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019621 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19622
19623 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019624
19625res.body_size : integer
19626 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19627 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19628 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19629 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019630 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19631
19632 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019633
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019634res.cache_hit : boolean
19635 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19636 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19637
19638res.cache_name : string
19639 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19640 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19641 empty string.
19642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019643res.comp : boolean
19644 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19645 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19646 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019648res.comp_algo : string
19649 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19650 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19651 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019653res.cook([<name>]) : string
19654scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19655 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19656 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019657 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19658
19659 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019661 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019662 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019664res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19665scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19666 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19667 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019668 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19669
19670 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019672res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19673scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19674 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19675 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019676 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19677
19678 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019680res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019681 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19682 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19683
19684 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19685 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19686
19687 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19688
19689 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019691res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019692 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19693 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19694
19695 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19696 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19697
19698 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019700res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19701shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019702 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19703 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19704
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019705 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019706 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19707
19708 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019710 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019711 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19712 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19713 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19714 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19715 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19716 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19717 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19718 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019719
19720res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19721shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019722 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19723 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19724
19725 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019726 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019727
19728 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019730res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19731shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019732 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19733 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19734
19735 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19736
19737 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019738
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019739res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19740 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19741 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19742 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019743 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19744
19745 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019747res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19748shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019749 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19750 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19751
19752 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19753
19754 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019755
19756res.hdrs : string
19757 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19758 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19759 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019760 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19761
19762 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019763
19764res.hdrs_bin : binary
19765 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19766 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19767 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19768 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19769 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19770 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19771 (length of 0 for both).
19772
19773 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19774
19775 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19776 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019778res.ver : string
19779resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19780 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019781 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19782
19783 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019785 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019786 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019788set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19789 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19790 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019791 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019792 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019794 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19795 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019797status : integer
19798 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19799 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019800 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19801
19802 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019803
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019804unique-id : string
19805 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19806 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19807 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19808 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19809 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19810 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019812url : string
19813 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19814 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19815 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19816 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19817 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19818 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19819 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019821 ACL derivatives :
19822 url : exact string match
19823 url_beg : prefix match
19824 url_dir : subdir match
19825 url_dom : domain match
19826 url_end : suffix match
19827 url_len : length match
19828 url_reg : regex match
19829 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019831url_ip : ip
19832 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19833 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19834 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19835 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19836 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19837 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19838 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019840url_port : integer
19841 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19842 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19843 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19844 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019845
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019846urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19847url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019848 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19849 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019850 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19851 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19852 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19853 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019854 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19855 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019856 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19857 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019859 ACL derivatives :
19860 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19861 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19862 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19863 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19864 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19865 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19866 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19867 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019868
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019870 Example :
19871 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19872 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19873 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19874 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019875
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019876urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019877 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19878 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19879 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019880
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019881url32 : integer
19882 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19883 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19884 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19885 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19886 is an unsigned integer.
19887
19888url32+src : binary
19889 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19890 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19891 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19892
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019893
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200198947.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019895---------------------------------------
19896
19897This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19898used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19899purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19900There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19901or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19902any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19903for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19904
19905internal.htx.data : integer
19906 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19907 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19908
19909internal.htx.free : integer
19910 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19911 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19912
19913internal.htx.free_data : integer
19914 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19915 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19916
19917internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019918 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19919 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19920 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019921
19922internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19923 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19924 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19925
19926internal.htx.size : integer
19927 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19928 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19929
19930internal.htx.used : integer
19931 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19932 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19933 direction.
19934
19935internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19936 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19937 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19938 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19939 of the special value :
19940 * head : The oldest inserted block
19941 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019942 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019943
19944internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19945 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19946 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19947 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19948 integer or one of the special value :
19949 * head : The oldest inserted block
19950 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019951 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019952
19953internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19954 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19955 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19956 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19957 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19958
19959 * head : The oldest inserted block
19960 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019961 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019962
19963internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19964 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19965 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19966 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19967 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19968
19969 * head : The oldest inserted block
19970 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019971 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019972
19973internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19974 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19975 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19976 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19977 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19978
19979 * head : The oldest inserted block
19980 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019981 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019982
19983internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19984 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19985 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19986 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19987 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19988
19989 * head : The oldest inserted block
19990 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019991 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019992
19993internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19994 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19995 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19996 it returns false.
19997
19998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200199997.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020000---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020002Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20003every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020004order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020006ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020007---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20008FALSE always_false never match
20009HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20010HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20011HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020012HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020013HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20014HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20015HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20016HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20017LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20018METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20019METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20020METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20021METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20022METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20023METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20024METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20025METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20026RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20027REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20028TRUE always_true always match
20029WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20030---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020031
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200338. Logging
20034----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020035
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020036One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20037provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20038very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20039provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20040state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020041to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020042headers.
20043
20044In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20045about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20046send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20047
20048 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20049 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20050 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20051 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20052 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020053 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020054 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020055
20056The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20057allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20058as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20059while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20060real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20061delay.
20062
20063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200648.1. Log levels
20065---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020066
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020067TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020068source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020069HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20070in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20071track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20072syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20073about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020074
20075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200768.2. Log formats
20077----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020078
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020079HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020080and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20081slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20082options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020083
20084 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20085 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20086 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20087 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20088 extents.
20089
20090 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20091 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20092 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20093 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20094 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20095
20096 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20097 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20098 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20099 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20100 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20101
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020102 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20103 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20104 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20105 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20106
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020107 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20108
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020109Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20110specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20111field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20112servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20113always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20114identifier.
20115
20116Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20117 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20118 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20119 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20120 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20121
20122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201238.2.1. Default log format
20124-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020125
20126This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20127as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20128format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20129
20130 Example :
20131 listen www
20132 mode http
20133 log global
20134 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20135
20136 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20137 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20138 (www/HTTP)
20139
20140 Field Format Extract from the example above
20141 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20142 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20143 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20144 4 'to' to
20145 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20146 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20147
20148Detailed fields description :
20149 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20150 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20151 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20152 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20153 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20154 and processed the connection.
20155 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20156
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020157In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20158"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20159connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20160
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020161It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20162will eventually disappear.
20163
20164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201658.2.2. TCP log format
20166---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020167
20168The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20169is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20170information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20171counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20172emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20173environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20174the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20175sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020176specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20177not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20178fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20179marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020180
20181 Example :
20182 frontend fnt
20183 mode tcp
20184 option tcplog
20185 log global
20186 default_backend bck
20187
20188 backend bck
20189 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20190
20191 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20192 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20193 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20194
20195 Field Format Extract from the example above
20196 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20197 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20198 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20199 4 frontend_name fnt
20200 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20201 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20202 7 bytes_read* 212
20203 8 termination_state --
20204 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20205 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20206
20207Detailed fields description :
20208 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020209 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020210 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20211 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020212 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020213 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020214 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020215
20216 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020217 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20218 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20219 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020220
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020221 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020222 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20223 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020224 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20225 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20226 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20227 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020228
20229 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20230 and processed the connection.
20231
20232 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20233 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20234 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20235 applications.
20236
20237 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20238 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20239 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20240 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20241 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20242
20243 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20244 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20245 See "Timers" below for more details.
20246
20247 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20248 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20249 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20250 "Timers" below for more details.
20251
20252 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020253 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020254 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20255 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20256 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20257 details.
20258
20259 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20260 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20261 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20262 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20263 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20264
20265 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20266 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20267 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20268 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20269 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20270 for more details.
20271
20272 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020273 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020274 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20275 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20276 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020277 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020278
20279 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20280 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20281 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20282 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20283 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20284 caused by a denial of service attack.
20285
20286 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20287 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20288 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20289 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20290 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20291 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20292 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20293 denial of service attack.
20294
20295 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20296 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20297 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20298 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20299 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20300 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20301 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20302 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20303 be processed than on other servers.
20304
20305 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20306 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20307 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20308 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020309 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020310 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20311 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20312 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20313 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20314 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20315 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20316 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20317 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20318
20319 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20320 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20321 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20322 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20323 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20324 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020325 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020326 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20327
20328 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20329 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20330 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20331 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20332 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20333 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020334 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020335 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20336 occurs.
20337
20338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203398.2.3. HTTP log format
20340----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020341
20342The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20343is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20344the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20345are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20346emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20347generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20348"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20349which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020350frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20351is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020352
20353Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20354slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20355with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20356
20357 Example :
20358 frontend http-in
20359 mode http
20360 option httplog
20361 log global
20362 default_backend bck
20363
20364 backend static
20365 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20366
20367 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20368 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20369 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020370 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020371
20372 Field Format Extract from the example above
20373 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20374 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020375 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020376 4 frontend_name http-in
20377 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020378 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020379 7 status_code 200
20380 8 bytes_read* 2750
20381 9 captured_request_cookie -
20382 10 captured_response_cookie -
20383 11 termination_state ----
20384 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20385 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20386 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20387 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20388 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020389
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020390Detailed fields description :
20391 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020392 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020393 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20394 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020395 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020396 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020397 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020398
20399 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020400 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20401 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20402 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020403
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020404 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020405 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020406
20407 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20408 and processed the connection.
20409
20410 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20411 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20412 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20413
20414 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20415 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20416 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20417 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20418 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20419 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20420
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020421 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20422 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20423 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020424 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020425 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20426 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020427 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020428 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020429
20430 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20431 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020432 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020433
20434 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20435 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020436 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20437 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020438
20439 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20440 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20441 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20442 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20443 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020444 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20445 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020446
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020447 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020448 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20449 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20450 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20451 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20452 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20453 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020454 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020455
20456 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020457 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20458 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020459
20460 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20461 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020462 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020463 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20464 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20465 overflowing.
20466
20467 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20468 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20469 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20470 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20471 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20472 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20473 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20474 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20475
20476 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20477 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20478 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20479 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20480 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20481 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20482 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20483 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20484
20485 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20486 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20487 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20488 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20489 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20490 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20491 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20492
20493 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020494 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020495 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20496 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20497 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020498 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020499 system.
20500
20501 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20502 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20503 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20504 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20505 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20506 caused by a denial of service attack.
20507
20508 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20509 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20510 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20511 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20512 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20513 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20514 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20515 denial of service attack.
20516
20517 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20518 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20519 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20520 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20521 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20522 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20523 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20524 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20525 processed than on other servers.
20526
20527 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20528 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20529 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20530 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020531 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020532 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20533 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20534 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20535 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20536 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20537 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20538 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20539 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20540
20541 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20542 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20543 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20544 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20545 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20546 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020547 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020548 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20549
20550 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20551 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20552 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20553 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20554 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20555 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020556 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020557 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20558 occurs.
20559
20560 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20561 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20562 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20563 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20564 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20565 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20566 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20567 cookies" below for more details.
20568
20569 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20570 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20571 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20572 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20573 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20574 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20575 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20576 and cookies" below for more details.
20577
20578 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20579 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20580 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20581 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20582 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20583 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20584 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20585 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20586
20587
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200205888.2.4. Custom log format
20589------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020590
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020591The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020592mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020593
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020594HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020595Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20596separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20597prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20598
20599Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20600variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020601("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020602
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020603If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020604as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020605less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20606the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20607
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020608Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20609"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20610delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20611preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020612
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020613Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20614'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20615https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20616such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20617
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020618Flags are :
20619 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020620 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020621 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20622 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020623
20624 Example:
20625
20626 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20627 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20628
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020629 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20630
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020631At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20632
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020633 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20634 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020635
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020636the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020637
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020638 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20639 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20640 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020641
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020642and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20643
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020644 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20645 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020646
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020647Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20648
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020649 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020650 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020651 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20652 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20653 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020654 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20655 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20656 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020657 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020658 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020659 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020660 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020661 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020662 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20663 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020664 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020665 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020666 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020667 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020668 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020669 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020670 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020671 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20672 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20673 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20674 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20675 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020676 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020677 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020678 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020679 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020680 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020681 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20682 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020683 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20684 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20685 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020686 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020687 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20688 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020689 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020690 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20691 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20692 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020693 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020694 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020695 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20696 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20697 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20698 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020699 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020700 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020701 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020702 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020703 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020704 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020705 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20706 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20707 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020708 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020709 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20710 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020711 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020712 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20713 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020714 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020715 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020716 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020717 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020718
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020719 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020720
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020721
207228.2.5. Error log format
20723-----------------------
20724
20725When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020726protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020727By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20728"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020729will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020730logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20731
20732The format looks like this :
20733
20734 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20735 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20736 Connection error during SSL handshake
20737
20738 Field Format Extract from the example above
20739 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20740 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20741 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20742 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20743 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20744
20745These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20746failures.
20747
20748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207498.3. Advanced logging options
20750-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020751
20752Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20753just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20754options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20755for more information about their usage.
20756
20757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207588.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20759------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020760
20761It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020762HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020763commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20764monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20765ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20766
20767 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20768 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20769 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20770 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20771
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020772 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20773 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020774
20775 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20776 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20777 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20778
20779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20781----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020782
20783The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20784what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20785or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020786"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020787just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20788log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20789after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20790is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20791with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20792with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20793
20794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207958.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20796------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020797
20798Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20799for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20800"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20801retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20802raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20803a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20804file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20805you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20806"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20807
20808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20810--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020811
20812Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20813multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20814them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20815"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20816logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20817error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20818and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20819too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20820useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20821alternative.
20822
20823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208248.4. Timing events
20825------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020826
20827Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20828reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20829the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20830frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020831mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20832addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20833
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020834Timings events in HTTP mode:
20835
20836 first request 2nd request
20837 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20838 t tr t tr ...
20839 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20840 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20841 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20842 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020843 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020844 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20845
20846Timings events in TCP mode:
20847
20848 TCP session
20849 |<----------------->|
20850 t t
20851 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20852 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20853 |<------ Tt ------->|
20854
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020855 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020856 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020857 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20858 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20859 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020860 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020861 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20862 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20863 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20864 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020865
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020866 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20867 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20868 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020869 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20870 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20871 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20872 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20873 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20874 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020875
20876 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20877 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20878 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20879 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20880 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20881 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20882 request typed by hand during a test.
20883
20884 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20885 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020886 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020887 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20888 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20889 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20890 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020891
20892 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20893 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20894 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20895 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20896 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20897
20898 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20899 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20900 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20901 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20902 connection never established.
20903
20904 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20905 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20906 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20907 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20908 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20909 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20910 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20911 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20912 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20913 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20914 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20915
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020916 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20917 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20918 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20919 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20920 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20921 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20922
20923 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20924
20925 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20926 "Ta" can never be negative.
20927
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020928 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20929 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020930 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20931 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020932 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020933
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020934 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020935
20936 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020937 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20938 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020939
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020940 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20941 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20942 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20943 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20944 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20945 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20946 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20947 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20948
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020949These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20950protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20951that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020952due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20953"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20954that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020955
20956Most common cases :
20957
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020958 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20959 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20960 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20961 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20962 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020963 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020964 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20965 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20966 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20967 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20968 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020969 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020970
20971 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20972 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20973 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20974 of ms on remote networks.
20975
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020976 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20977 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20978 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020979
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020980 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20981 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020982 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020983 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20984 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20985 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20986 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20987 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20988 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020989
20990Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20991
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020992 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020993 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020994 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020995
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020996 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020997 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20998 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20999
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021000 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021001 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21002 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21003 flags.
21004
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021005 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21006 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021007 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21008 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21009 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21010 the client connection was maintained open.
21011
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021012 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021013 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021014 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021015 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21016
21017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210188.5. Session state at disconnection
21019-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021020
21021TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21022"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
210232-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21024each of which has a special meaning :
21025
21026 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21027 session to terminate :
21028
21029 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21030
21031 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21032 server explicitly refused it.
21033
21034 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21035 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21036 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21037 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021038 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021039
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021040 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021041 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021042
21043 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21044 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21045 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21046 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21047 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21048
21049 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21050 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21051 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21052 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21053 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21054
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021055 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021056 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21057
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021058 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021059 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21060 backup connections when going up.
21061
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021062 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021063
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021064 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21065 send or receive data.
21066
21067 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21068 send or receive data.
21069
21070 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21071 with nothing left in the buffers.
21072
21073 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21074
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021075 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021076 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21077
21078 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21079 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21080 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21081 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21082 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21083
21084 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21085 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21086
21087 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21088 server (HTTP only).
21089
21090 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21091
21092 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21093 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21094 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21095
21096 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21097 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21098 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21099
21100 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21101
21102 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21103 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21104
21105 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21106 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21107 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21108
21109 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21110 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021111 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21112 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021113
21114 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21115 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21116 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21117 another server.
21118
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021119 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021120 server.
21121
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021122 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21123 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21124 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21125 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21126
21127 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21128 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21129 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21130 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21131
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021132 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21133 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21134 "use-server" rule).
21135
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021136 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21137
21138 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21139 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21140
21141 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21142
21143 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21144 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21145 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21146
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021147 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21148 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021149 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021150 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21151 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21152
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021153 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21154
21155 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21156 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21157
21158 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21159
21160 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21161
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021162The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21163was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021164helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21165starvation, attacks, etc...
21166
21167The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21168alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21169easier finding and understanding.
21170
21171 Flags Reason
21172
21173 -- Normal termination.
21174
21175 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021176 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21177 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021178 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21179
21180 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21181 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021182 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21183 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021184 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21185 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021186
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021187 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21188 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021189 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021190
21191 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21192 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21193 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21194
21195 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21196 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21197 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21198 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21199 the server takes too long to respond.
21200
21201 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21202 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21203 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21204 long a time to respond.
21205
21206 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21207 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21208 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021209 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021210 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21211 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021212
21213 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21214 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21215 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21216 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21217 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021218 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021219 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21220 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21221 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21222 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21223 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21224 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21225 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21226 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021227 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021228 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21229 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21230 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021231
21232 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21233 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021234 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21235 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21236 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21237 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021238
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021239 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021240 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21241
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021242 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021243 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21244 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021245 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021246 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21247 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21248
21249 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21250 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21251 503 or 504 here.
21252
21253 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021254 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021255 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21256 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21257 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21258
21259 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21260 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021261 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021262 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021263 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021264
21265 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21266 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21267 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21268 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21269 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21270 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021271 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021272
21273 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21274 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21275 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21276 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21277 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21278 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21279 solution is to fix the application.
21280
21281 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21282 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21283 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21284 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21285 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21286 external attacks.
21287
21288 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021289 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021290 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021291 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21292 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21293
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021294 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21295 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21296 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021297 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021298 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021299
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021300 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21301 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21302 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21303 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021304 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21305 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21306 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21307 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021308 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21309 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21310 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21311 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021312
21313 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21314 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21315 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021316 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21317 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21318 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21319 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021320
21321 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21322 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21323 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21324 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21325
21326 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21327 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21328 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21329 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21330
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021331The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021332persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021333important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21334re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21335
21336 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21337
21338 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21339 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21340 set on a GET request.
21341
21342 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21343 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021344 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021345 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21346
21347 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21348 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21349 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21350
21351 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21352 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21353 already got a cookie.
21354
21355 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21356 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21357 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21358 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21359 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21360
21361 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21362 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21363 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21364
21365 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21366 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21367 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21368
21369 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21370 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21371
21372 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21373 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21374 then advertised in the response.
21375
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213778.6. Non-printable characters
21378-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021379
21380In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21381consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21382converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21383prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21384being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21385escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21386is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21387'}' when logging headers.
21388
21389Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21390issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21391containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21392
21393Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21394the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21395performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21396
21397
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213988.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21399---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021400
21401Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21402achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021403section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021404cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21405the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21406the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021407locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021408not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21409user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21410a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21411wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21412
21413 Examples :
21414 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21415 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21416
21417 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21418 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21419
21420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214218.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21422---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021423
21424Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21425proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21426the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21427server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21428
21429Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21430response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021431section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021432
21433It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021434time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21435appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021436are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21437and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21438follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21439request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21440in the logs.
21441
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021442As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21443frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21444an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21445
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021446 Example :
21447 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21448 listen proxy-out
21449 mode http
21450 option httplog
21451 option logasap
21452 log global
21453 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21454
21455 # log the name of the virtual server
21456 capture request header Host len 20
21457
21458 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21459 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21460
21461 # log the beginning of the referrer
21462 capture request header Referer len 20
21463
21464 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21465 capture response header Server len 20
21466
21467 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21468 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21469
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021470 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021471 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21472
21473 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21474 capture response header Via len 20
21475
21476 # log the URL location during a redirection
21477 capture response header Location len 20
21478
21479 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21480 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21481 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21482 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21483 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21484
21485 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21486 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21487 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21488 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021489 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021490
21491 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21492 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21493 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21494 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21495 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021496 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021497
21498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214998.9. Examples of logs
21500---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021501
21502These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21503them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21504reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21505
21506 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21507 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21508 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21509
21510 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21511 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21512
21513 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21514 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21515 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21516
21517 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21518 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21519
21520 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21521 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21522 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21523
21524 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021525 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021526 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21527 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21528
21529 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21530 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21531 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21532
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021533 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21534 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21535 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21536 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021537 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021538 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021539
21540 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021541 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021542
21543 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21544 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21545 Nothing was sent to any server.
21546
21547 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21548 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21549
21550 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21551 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021552 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021553 send a 408 return code to the client.
21554
21555 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21556 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21557
21558 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21559 5 seconds ("c----").
21560
21561 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21562 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021563 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021564
21565 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021566 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021567 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21568 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21569 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21570 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21571 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021572
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021573
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200215749. Supported filters
21575--------------------
21576
21577Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21578accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21579unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21580
21581See also : "filter"
21582
215839.1. Trace
21584----------
21585
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021586filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021587
21588 Arguments:
21589 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21590 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21591
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021592 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021593
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021594 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021595 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21596 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21597 amount of the parsed data.
21598
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021599 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021600
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021601This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21602callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21603information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21604filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21605
21606Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21607tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21608a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21609
21610
216119.2. HTTP compression
21612---------------------
21613
21614filter compression
21615
21616The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21617keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021618when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21619fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21620done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21621explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21622filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21623listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21624order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021625
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021626See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21627 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021628
21629
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200216309.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21631--------------------------------------------
21632
21633filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21634
21635 Arguments :
21636
21637 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21638 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21639 parsed.
21640
21641 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21642 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21643 part must be placed in its own scope.
21644
21645The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21646external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021647streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021648exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21649also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21650
21651SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21652the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21653
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021654For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021655"doc/SPOE.txt".
21656
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100216579.4. Cache
21658----------
21659
21660filter cache <name>
21661
21662 Arguments :
21663
21664 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21665
21666The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21667"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021668cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021669other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21670case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21671is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21672filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021673listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21674order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021675
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021676See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21677 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21678
21679
216809.5. Fcgi-app
21681-------------
21682
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021683filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021684
21685 Arguments :
21686
21687 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21688
21689The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21690request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21691reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21692used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21693implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21694used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21695fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21696used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21697order.
21698
21699See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21700 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21701
21702
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100217039.6. OpenTracing
21704----------------
21705
21706The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21707HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21708of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21709Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21710
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021711This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021712
21713The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21714HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21715participates in the work of HAProxy.
21716
21717filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21718
21719 Arguments :
21720
21721 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21722 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21723 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21724 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21725 OpenTracing filters.
21726
21727 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21728 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21729 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21730 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21731 filter must have its own scope defined.
21732
21733More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021734of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021735
21736
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002173710. FastCGI applications
21738-------------------------
21739
21740HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21741feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21742the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21743FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21744servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21745FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21746backend.
21747
21748HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21749application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21750connection.
21751
2175210.1. Setup
21753-----------
21754
2175510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21756--------------------------
21757
21758fcgi-app <name>
21759 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21760 document root must be defined.
21761
21762acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21763 Declare or complete an access list.
21764
21765 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21766 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21767 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21768 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21769 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21770
21771docroot <path>
21772 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21773 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21774 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21775
21776index <script-name>
21777 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21778 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21779 is an optional setting.
21780
21781 Example :
21782 index index.php
21783
21784log-stderr global
21785log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021786 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021787 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21788
21789 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21790 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21791
21792pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21793 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21794 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21795 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21796
21797 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21798 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21799 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21800 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21801
21802 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21803 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21804
21805path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021806 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021807 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21808 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21809 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21810 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21811 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21812 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21813 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021814
21815 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021816 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021817 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21818 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21819 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21820 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021821
21822 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021823 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21824 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021825
21826option get-values
21827no option get-values
21828 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21829
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021830 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021831 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21832
21833 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21834 application will accept.
21835
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021836 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21837 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021838
21839 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021840 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021841 option is disabled.
21842
21843 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21844 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21845 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21846 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21847 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21848 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21849
21850option keep-conn
21851no option keep-conn
21852 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21853 sending a response.
21854
21855 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21856 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21857
21858option max-reqs <reqs>
21859 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21860 accept.
21861
21862 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21863 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21864 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21865 to 1.
21866
21867option mpxs-conns
21868no option mpxs-conns
21869 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21870
21871 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21872 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21873
21874set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21875 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21876 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21877 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21878 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21879
21880 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21881 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21882 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21883
21884 Example :
21885 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21886 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21887
21888 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21889
21890
2189110.1.2. Proxy section
21892---------------------
21893
21894use-fcgi-app <name>
21895 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21896
21897 Arguments :
21898 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21899
21900 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21901 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21902 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21903 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21904 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21905
21906 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21907 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21908 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21909 application are evaluated.
21910
21911
2191210.1.3. Example
21913---------------
21914
21915 frontend front-http
21916 mode http
21917 bind *:80
21918 bind *:
21919
21920 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21921 default_backend back-static
21922
21923 backend back-static
21924 mode http
21925 server www A.B.C.D:80
21926
21927 backend back-dynamic
21928 mode http
21929 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21930 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21931
21932 fcgi-app php-fpm
21933 log-stderr global
21934 option keep-conn
21935
21936 docroot /var/www/my-app
21937 index index.php
21938 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21939
21940
2194110.2. Default parameters
21942------------------------
21943
21944A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21945the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021946script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021947applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21948
21949 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21950 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21951 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21952 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21953 | | |
21954 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21955 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21956 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21957 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21958 | | application. |
21959 | | |
21960 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21961 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21962 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21963 | | |
21964 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21965 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21966 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21967 | | the application's configuration. |
21968 | | |
21969 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21970 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21971 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21972 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21973 | | |
21974 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21975 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21976 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21977 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21978 | | be defined. |
21979 | | |
21980 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21981 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21982 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21983 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21984 | | is not set too. |
21985 | | |
21986 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21987 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21988 | | set. |
21989 | | |
21990 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21991 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21992 | | the request. |
21993 | | |
21994 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21995 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21996 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21997 | | |
21998 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21999 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22000 | | script to process the request. |
22001 | | |
22002 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22003 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22004 | | |
22005 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22006 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22007 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22008 | | |
22009 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22010 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22011 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22012 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22013 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22014 | | |
22015 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22016 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22017 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22018 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22019 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22020 | | side. |
22021 | | |
22022 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22023 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22024 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22025 | | connected to. |
22026 | | |
22027 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22028 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22029 | | |
22030 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022031 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22032 | | current HAProxy version. |
22033 | | |
22034 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022035 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22036 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22037 | | |
22038 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22039
22040
2204110.3. Limitations
22042------------------
22043
22044The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22045way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22046during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22047establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22048application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22049or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22050message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22051these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22052and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22053
22054Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22055request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22056requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22057
22058About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22059into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22060fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22061"http-request" ones.
22062
22063Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22064FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22065processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22066must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22067here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022068
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022069
2207011. Address formats
22071-------------------
22072
22073Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22074address.
22075
22076This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22077The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22078of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22079equivalent is '::'.
22080
22081Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22082is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22083
22084This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22085family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22086
22087Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22088configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22089use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22090'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22091
22092Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22093socket type and the transport method.
22094
22095
2209611.1 Address family prefixes
22097----------------------------
22098
22099'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22100
22101'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22102 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22103 listening.
22104
22105'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22106 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22107 on the statement using this address, a port or
22108 a port range may or must be specified.
22109
22110'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22111 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22112 using this address, a port or a port range
22113 may or must be specified.
22114
22115'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22116 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22117 using this address, a port or a port range
22118 may or must be specified.
22119
22120'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22121 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22122 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22123 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22124 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22125 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22126
22127'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22128 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22129 start by slash '/'.
22130
22131
2213211.2 Socket type prefixes
22133-------------------------
22134
22135Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22136type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22137this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22138This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22139but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22140
22141Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22142instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22143
22144If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22145they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22146report this to the maintainers.
22147
22148'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22149 to "stream"
22150
22151'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22152 to "datagram".
22153
22154
2215511.3 Protocol prefixes
22156----------------------
22157
22158'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22159 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22160 socket type and transport method is forced to
22161 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22162 this address, a port or a port range can or
22163 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22164 of 'stream+ip@'.
22165
22166'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22167 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22168 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22169 statement using this address, a port or port
22170 range can or must be specified.
22171 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22172
22173'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22174 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22175 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22176 statement using this address, a port or port
22177 range can or must be specified.
22178 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22179
22180'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22181 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22182 socket type and transport method is forced to
22183 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22184 this address, a port or a port range can or
22185 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22186 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22187
22188'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22189 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22190 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22191 the statement using this address, a port or
22192 port range can or must be specified.
22193 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22194
22195'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22196 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22197 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22198 the statement using this address, a port or
22199 port range can or must be specified.
22200 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22201
22202'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22203 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22204 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22205
22206'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22207 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22208 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22209
22210In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22211QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22212
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022213/*
22214 * Local variables:
22215 * fill-column: 79
22216 * End:
22217 */